blob: 9a3cb442a75bac668b764860510364aab6953369 [file] [log] [blame]
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner0bc735f2007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall2d887082010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregore737f502010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
17#include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbarc4a1dea2008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +000022#include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000023#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Narofff494b572008-05-29 21:12:08 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +000026#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000027#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000028#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000029#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000030#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000031#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
32#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
John McCall19510852010-08-20 18:27:03 +000033#include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
34#include "clang/Sema/Designator.h"
35#include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +000036#include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h"
John McCall19510852010-08-20 18:27:03 +000037#include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
John McCall7cd088e2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000038#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000039using namespace clang;
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +000040using namespace sema;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000041
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +000042
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000043/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
44/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
45///
46/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
47/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
48/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
49/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
50/// function is being used.
51///
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000052/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
53/// decls.
54///
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000055/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
56/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000057///
John McCall54abf7d2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000058bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000059 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Fariborz Jahanianc4b35cf2010-10-06 21:18:44 +000060 if (const DeprecatedAttr *DA = D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) {
61 const char *Message =
Fariborz Jahaniandf9fb912010-10-06 22:20:08 +000062 DA->getMessage().empty() ? 0 : DA->getMessage().data();
Fariborz Jahanianc4b35cf2010-10-06 21:18:44 +000063 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, Message, Loc);
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000064 }
65
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000066 // See if the decl is unavailable
Fariborz Jahanianc784dc12010-10-06 23:12:32 +000067 if (const UnavailableAttr *UA = D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
68 if (UA->getMessage().empty())
69 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
70 else
71 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable_message)
72 << D->getDeclName() << UA->getMessage().data();
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000073 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
74 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +000075
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000076 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000077 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000078 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
79 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
80 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
81 return true;
82 }
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000083 }
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000084
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000085 return false;
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000086}
87
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +000088/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000089/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +000090/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
91///
92void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000093 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000094 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000095 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000096 return;
Douglas Gregor92e986e2010-04-22 16:44:27 +000097
98 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
99 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000100 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
101 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000102
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +0000103 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
104 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000105 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000106 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
107 int isMethod = 0;
108 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
109 // skip over named parameters.
110 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
111 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
112 if (nullPos)
113 --nullPos;
114 else
115 ++i;
116 }
117 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
118 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000119 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000120 // skip over named parameters.
121 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
122 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
123 if (nullPos)
124 --nullPos;
125 else
126 ++i;
127 }
128 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000129 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000130 // block or function pointer call.
131 QualType Ty = V->getType();
132 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000133 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000134 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
135 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000136 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
137 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
138 unsigned k;
139 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
140 if (nullPos)
141 --nullPos;
142 else
143 ++i;
144 }
145 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
146 }
147 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
148 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000149 } else
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000150 return;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000151 } else
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000152 return;
153
154 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000155 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000156 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000157 return;
158 }
159 int sentinel = i;
160 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
161 --sentinelPos;
162 ++i;
163 }
164 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
165 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000166 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000167 return;
168 }
169 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
170 ++i;
171 ++sentinel;
172 }
173 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000174 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
175 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
176 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
Fariborz Jahanian9ccd7252010-07-14 16:37:51 +0000177 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000178 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
179 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
180 return;
181
182 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
183 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
184
185 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
186 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000187}
188
Douglas Gregor4b2d3f72009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000189SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
190 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
191 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
192}
193
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000194//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
195// Standard Promotions and Conversions
196//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
197
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000198/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
199void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
200 QualType Ty = E->getType();
201 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
202
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000203 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000204 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000205 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000206 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
207 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
208 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
209 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
210 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
211 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
212 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc39a3d72008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000213 //
214 // C++ 4.2p1:
215 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
216 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
217 //
218 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
219 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson112a0a82009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000220 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000221 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000222 }
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000223}
224
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000225void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
226 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000227
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000228 QualType Ty = E->getType();
229 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
230 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
231 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
232 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
233 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
234 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
235 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
236 // rvalue is T
237 //
238 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000239 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
240 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000241 // type of the lvalue.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000242 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CK_NoOp);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000243 }
244}
245
246
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000247/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000248/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000249/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
250/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
251/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
252Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
253 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
254 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000255
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000256 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
257 //
258 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
259 // unsigned int may be used:
260 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
261 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
262 // and unsigned int.
263 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
264 //
265 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
266 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
267 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
268 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000269 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
270 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000271 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000272 return Expr;
273 }
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000274 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000275 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000276 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000277 return Expr;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000278 }
279
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000280 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000281 return Expr;
282}
283
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000284/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000285/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000286/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
287void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
288 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
289 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000290
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000291 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000292 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
293 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000294 CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000295
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000296 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
297}
298
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000299/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
300/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
301/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
302/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000303bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
304 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000305 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000306
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000307 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
308 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
309 // etc.
310 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
311 return false;
312
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000313 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000314 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
315 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
316 << Expr->getType() << CT))
317 return true;
Douglas Gregor75b699a2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000318
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000319 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000320 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000321 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
322 << Expr->getType() << CT))
323 return true;
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000324
325 return false;
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000326}
327
328
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000329/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
330/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000331/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000332/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
333/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
334/// GCC.
335QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
336 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000337 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000338 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000339
340 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000341
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000342 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000343 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000344 QualType lhs =
345 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000346 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000347 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000348
349 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
350 if (lhs == rhs)
351 return lhs;
352
353 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
354 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
355 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
356 return lhs;
357
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000358 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000359 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000360 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
361 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000362 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000363 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
364 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
365
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000366 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000367 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000368 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
369 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000370 return destType;
371}
372
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000373//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
374// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
375//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
376
377
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000378/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000379/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
380/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
381/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
382/// string.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000383///
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000384ExprResult
Sean Hunt6cf75022010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000385Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000386 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
387
Chris Lattnerbbee00b2009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000388 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000389 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000390 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000391
392 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
393 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
394 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000395
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000396 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis55f4b022008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000397 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000398 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000399
400 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattner7dc480f2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000401 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000402 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000403
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000404 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
405 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
406 // strings.
407 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerdbb1ecc2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000408 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000409 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000410
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000411 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Sean Hunt6cf75022010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000412 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
413 Literal.GetStringLength(),
414 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
415 &StringTokLocs[0],
416 StringTokLocs.size()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000417}
418
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000419/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
420/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
421/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
422/// for values inside the block or for globals).
423///
Douglas Gregor076ceb02010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000424/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000425/// up-to-date.
426///
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000427static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000428 ValueDecl *VD) {
429 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
430 // we wanted to.
431 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
432 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000433
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000434 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
435 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
436 return false;
437
438 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
439 // snapshot it.
440 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
441 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000442 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
443 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000444
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000445 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
446 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
447
448 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
449 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
450 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
451 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000452 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
453 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000454
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000455 if (!NextBlock)
456 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000457
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000458 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
459 // having a reference outside it.
460 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
461 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000462
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000463 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
464 // a snapshot as well.
465 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
466 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000467
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000468 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000469}
470
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000471
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000472ExprResult
John McCalldbd872f2009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000473Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000474 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000475 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc);
476 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, NameInfo, SS);
477}
478
479/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000480ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000481Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty,
482 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
483 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000484 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000485 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000486 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000487 << D->getDeclName();
488 return ExprError();
489 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000490
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000491 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000492 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
493 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
494 // visible.
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +0000495 Ty = Ty.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000496 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000497 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
498 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000499 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
500 diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000501 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000502 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000503 << D->getIdentifier();
504 return ExprError();
505 }
506 }
507 }
508 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000509
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000510 MarkDeclarationReferenced(NameInfo.getLoc(), D);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000511
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000512 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
513 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
514 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000515 D, NameInfo, Ty));
Douglas Gregor1a49af92009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000516}
517
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000518/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
519/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
520/// actual member.
521///
522/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
523/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
524/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
525/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
526/// we found.
527///
528/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
529/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
530/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
531VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
532 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000533 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
534 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
535 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
536
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000537 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000538 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
539 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
540 do {
541 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCallbc365c52010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000542 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000543 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000544 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000545 else {
546 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
547 break;
548 }
549 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000550 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000551 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000552
553 return BaseObject;
554}
555
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000556ExprResult
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000557Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
558 FieldDecl *Field,
559 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
560 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
561 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000562 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000563 AnonFields);
564
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000565 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
566 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
567 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
568 // found via name lookup.
569 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000570 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000571 if (BaseObject) {
572 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
573 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000574 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000575 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000576 SourceLocation());
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000577 BaseQuals
578 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000579 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
580 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
581 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
582 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
583 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000584 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000585 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
586 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
587 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000588 BaseQuals
589 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000590 } else {
591 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
592 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
593 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000594 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
595 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000596 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000597 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000598 = Context.getTagDeclType(
599 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
600 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000601 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000602 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
603 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
604 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor8aa5f402009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000605 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000606 MD->getThisType(Context),
607 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000608 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
609 }
610 } else {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000611 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
612 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000613 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000614 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000615 }
616
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000617 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000618 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
619 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000620 }
621
622 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
623 // anonymous struct/union.
624 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000625 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000626 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
627 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
628 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
629 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000630 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
631 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
632
633 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
634 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
635 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
636 ResultQuals.removeConst();
637
638 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
639 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
640
641 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
642 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
643
644 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
645 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
646 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
647
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000648 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000649 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000650 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000651 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
652 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000653 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000654 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000655 }
656
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000657 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000658}
659
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000660/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000661/// possibly a list of template arguments.
662///
663/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
664/// DecomposeTemplateName.
665///
666/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
667/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
668/// some way.
669static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
670 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
671 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000672 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000673 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
674 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
675 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
676 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
677
678 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
679 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
680 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
681 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
682 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
683
John McCall2b5289b2010-08-23 07:28:44 +0000684 TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000685 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
686 NameInfo = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000687 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
688 } else {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000689 NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000690 TemplateArgs = 0;
691 }
692}
693
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000694/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
695/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
696/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000697static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000698 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
699 return false;
700
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000701 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
702 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
703 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
704 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
705 if (!BaseRT) return false;
706
707 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000708 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000709 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
710 return false;
711 }
712
713 return true;
714}
715
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000716/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
717/// the prospective base classes.
718static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
719 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
720 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000721 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000722 return false;
723
Douglas Gregor952b0172010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000724 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000725 if (!RD) return false;
726 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
727
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000728 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
729 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
730 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
731 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
732 if (!BaseRT) return false;
733
734 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000735 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
736 return false;
737 }
738
739 return true;
740}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000741
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000742enum IMAKind {
743 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
744 IMA_Static,
745
746 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
747 IMA_Mixed,
748
749 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
750 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
751 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
752
753 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
754 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
755 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
756
757 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
758 IMA_Instance,
759
760 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
761 IMA_Unresolved,
762
763 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
764 /// context is not an instance method.
765 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
766
767 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
768 /// non-class context.
769 IMA_AnonymousMember,
770
771 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
772 /// context is not an instance method.
773 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
774
775 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
776 /// class.
777 IMA_Error_Unrelated
778};
779
780/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
781/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
782/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
783/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
784/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
785/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
786static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
787 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000788 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000789
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000790 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000791 bool isStaticContext =
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000792 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
793 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000794
795 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
796 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
797
798 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
799 bool hasNonInstance = false;
800 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
801 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000802 NamedDecl *D = *I;
803 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000804 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
805
806 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
807 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
808 // that's a special case.
809 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
810 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
811 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
812 }
813 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
814 }
815 else
816 hasNonInstance = true;
817 }
818
819 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
820 // member reference.
821 if (Classes.empty())
822 return IMA_Static;
823
824 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
825 // an implicit member reference.
826 if (isStaticContext)
827 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
828
829 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
830 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
831 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
832 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000833 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000834 Classes))
835 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
836
837 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
838}
839
840/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
841static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
842 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
843 const LookupResult &R) {
844 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
845 SourceRange Range(Loc);
846 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
847
848 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
849 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
850 if (MD->isStatic()) {
851 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
852 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
853 << Range << R.getLookupName();
854 return;
855 }
856 }
857
858 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
859 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
860 return;
861 }
862
863 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000864}
865
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000866/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
867///
868/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000869bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
870 CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000871 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
872
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000873 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000874 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000875 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
876 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000877 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000878 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000879 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
880 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000881
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000882 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
883 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
884 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
885 // dependent name.
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000886 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000887 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000888 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
889 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
890
891 if (!R.empty()) {
892 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
893 R.suppressDiagnostics();
894
895 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
896 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
897 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
898 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
899
900 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
901 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
902 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000903 if (isInstance) {
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000904 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
905 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000906 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000907 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000908 if (DepMethod) {
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000909 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
910 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
911 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
912 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(
913 R.getNameLoc(), DepThisType, false);
914 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
915 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
916 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
917 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
918 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
919 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
920 ULE->getQualifier(), ULE->getQualifierRange(), NULL,
921 R.getLookupNameInfo(), &TList);
922 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000923 } else {
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000924 // FIXME: we should be able to handle this case too. It is correct
925 // to add this-> here. This is a workaround for PR7947.
926 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000927 }
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000928 } else {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000929 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000930 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000931
932 // Do we really want to note all of these?
933 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
934 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
935
936 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
937 return false;
938 }
Douglas Gregore26f0432010-08-09 22:38:14 +0000939
940 R.clear();
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000941 }
942 }
943
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000944 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000945 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbardc32cdf2010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000946 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000947 if (!R.empty()) {
948 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
949 if (SS.isEmpty())
950 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
951 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
952 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
953 else
954 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
955 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
956 << SS.getRange()
957 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
958 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
959 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
960 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
961 << ND->getDeclName();
962
963 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
964 return false;
965 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000966
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000967 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
968 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
969 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
970 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
971 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
972 // to recover well anyway.
973 if (SS.isEmpty())
974 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
975 else
976 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
977 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
978 << SS.getRange();
979
980 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
981 return true;
982 }
983 } else {
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000984 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000985 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000986 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000987 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000988 else
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000989 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000990 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
991 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000992 return true;
993 }
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000994 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000995 }
996
997 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
998 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
999 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
1000 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1001 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
1002 << SS.getRange();
1003 return true;
1004 }
1005
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001006 // Give up, we can't recover.
1007 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1008 return true;
1009}
1010
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001011static ObjCPropertyDecl *OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001012 IdentifierInfo *II,
1013 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001014 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
1015 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1016 if (!IDecl)
1017 return 0;
1018 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1019 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1020 return 0;
1021 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1022 if (!property)
1023 return 0;
1024 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1025 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
1026 return 0;
1027 return property;
1028}
1029
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001030static ObjCIvarDecl *SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001031 LookupResult &Lookup,
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001032 IdentifierInfo *II,
1033 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1034 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001035 bool LookForIvars;
1036 if (Lookup.empty())
1037 LookForIvars = true;
1038 else if (CurMeth->isClassMethod())
1039 LookForIvars = false;
1040 else
1041 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1042 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
1043 if (!LookForIvars)
1044 return 0;
1045
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001046 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1047 if (!IDecl)
1048 return 0;
1049 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
Fariborz Jahanian84ef4b22010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001050 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1051 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001052 bool DynamicImplSeen = false;
1053 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1054 if (!property)
1055 return 0;
1056 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1057 DynamicImplSeen =
1058 (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic);
1059 if (!DynamicImplSeen) {
Fariborz Jahanian84ef4b22010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001060 QualType PropType = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType(property->getType());
1061 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, ClassImpDecl,
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001062 NameLoc,
1063 II, PropType, /*Dinfo=*/0,
1064 ObjCIvarDecl::Protected,
1065 (Expr *)0, true);
1066 ClassImpDecl->addDecl(Ivar);
1067 IDecl->makeDeclVisibleInContext(Ivar, false);
1068 property->setPropertyIvarDecl(Ivar);
1069 return Ivar;
1070 }
1071 return 0;
1072}
1073
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001074ExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
John McCallfb97e752010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001075 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1076 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1077 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1078 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001079 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1080 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1081
1082 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor4c921ae2009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001083 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001084
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001085 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001086
1087 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001088 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001089 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001090 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001091
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001092 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
Douglas Gregor10c42622008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001093 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001094 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001095
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001096 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1097 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregor48026d22010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001098 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1099 // (note: handled after lookup)
1100 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1101 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1102 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001103 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1104 // names a dependent type.
1105 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1106 // we need to handle these differently.
Eli Friedman647c8b32010-08-06 23:41:47 +00001107 bool DependentID = false;
1108 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1109 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
1110 DependentID = true;
1111 } else if (SS.isSet()) {
1112 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
1113 if (DC) {
1114 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
1115 return ExprError();
1116 // FIXME: We should be checking whether DC is the current instantiation.
1117 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
1118 DependentID = !IsFullyFormedScope(*this, RD);
1119 } else {
1120 DependentID = true;
1121 }
1122 }
1123
1124 if (DependentID) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001125 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, NameInfo, isAddressOfOperand,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001126 TemplateArgs);
1127 }
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001128 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = false;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001129 // Perform the required lookup.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001130 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001131 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregord2235f62010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001132 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1133 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1134 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1135 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1136 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor1fd6d442010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001137 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1138 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1139 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001140 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001141 IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001142 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001143
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001144 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1145 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001146 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001147 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001148 if (E.isInvalid())
1149 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001150
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001151 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1152 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001153 // Synthesize ivars lazily
1154 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2) {
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001155 if (SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, R, II, NameLoc))
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001156 return ActOnIdExpression(S, SS, Id, HasTrailingLParen,
1157 isAddressOfOperand);
1158 }
Fariborz Jahanianf759b4d2010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001159 // for further use, this must be set to false if in class method.
1160 IvarLookupFollowUp = getCurMethodDecl()->isInstanceMethod();
Steve Naroffe3e9add2008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001161 }
Chris Lattner8a934232008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001162 }
Douglas Gregorc71e28c2009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001163
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001164 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1165 return ExprError();
1166
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001167 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1168 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001169 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001170
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001171 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001172 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001173 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1174 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1175 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1176 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1177 }
1178
1179 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1180 // call, diagnose the problem.
1181 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor91f7ac72010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001182 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001183 return ExprError();
1184
1185 assert(!R.empty() &&
1186 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001187
1188 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1189 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001190 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001191 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1192 R.clear();
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001193 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001194 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1195 return move(E);
1196 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001197 }
1198 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001199
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001200 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1201 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1202
1203 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001204 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI && IvarLookupFollowUp &&
Fariborz Jahanianb1d58e32010-07-29 16:53:53 +00001205 !getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2 &&
1206 Var->isFileVarDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001207 ObjCPropertyDecl *Property =
1208 OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, II, NameLoc);
1209 if (Property) {
1210 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_ivar_variable_conflict) << Var->getDeclName();
1211 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_property_declare);
Fariborz Jahanianf759b4d2010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001212 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_global_declared_at);
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001213 }
1214 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001215 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001216 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1217 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1218 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1219 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1220 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1221 // type.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001222 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001223 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001224
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001225 QualType T = Func->getType();
1226 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001227 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedman9a0fcfe2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001228 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1229 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001230 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001231 }
1232 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001233
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001234 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
John McCallfb97e752010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001235 // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3:
1236 // When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access
1237 // syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the
1238 // body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup
1239 // resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type
1240 // member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a
1241 // class member access expression using (*this) as the
1242 // postfix-expression to the left of the . operator.
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001243 //
1244 // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R
1245 // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the
1246 // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a
1247 // non-static member function:
1248 //
1249 // C++ [expr.ref]p4:
1250 // Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . .
1251 // [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a
1252 // member function call.
1253 //
1254 // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important
1255 // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a
1256 // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent
1257 // instance method.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001258 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001259 bool MightBeImplicitMember;
1260 if (!isAddressOfOperand)
1261 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
1262 else if (!SS.isEmpty())
1263 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
1264 else if (R.isOverloadedResult())
1265 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
Douglas Gregore2248be2010-08-30 16:00:47 +00001266 else if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
1267 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001268 else
1269 MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl());
1270
1271 if (MightBeImplicitMember)
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001272 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001273 }
1274
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001275 if (TemplateArgs)
1276 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001277
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001278 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1279}
1280
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001281/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001282ExprResult
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001283Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1284 LookupResult &R,
1285 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1286 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1287 case IMA_Instance:
1288 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1289
1290 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1291 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1292 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1293 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1294
1295 case IMA_Mixed:
1296 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1297 case IMA_Unresolved:
1298 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1299
1300 case IMA_Static:
1301 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1302 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1303 if (TemplateArgs)
1304 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1305 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1306
1307 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1308 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1309 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1310 return ExprError();
1311 }
1312
1313 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1314 return ExprError();
1315}
1316
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001317/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1318/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1319/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1320/// this path.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001321ExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001322Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001323 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001324 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001325 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001326 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, NameInfo, 0);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001327
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001328 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001329 return ExprError();
1330
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001331 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001332 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1333
1334 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1335 return ExprError();
1336
1337 if (R.empty()) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001338 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1339 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001340 return ExprError();
1341 }
1342
1343 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1344}
1345
1346/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1347/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1348/// additional lookup.
1349///
1350/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1351/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1352///
1353/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001354ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001355Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnereb483eb2010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001356 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001357 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001358 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001359
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001360 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1361 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1362 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1363 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1364 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1365
1366 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1367 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1368 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001369 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001370
1371 bool LookForIvars;
1372 if (Lookup.empty())
1373 LookForIvars = true;
1374 else if (IsClassMethod)
1375 LookForIvars = false;
1376 else
1377 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1378 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian412e7982010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001379 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001380 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001381 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001382 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1383 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1384 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1385 if (IsClassMethod)
1386 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1387 << IV->getDeclName());
1388
1389 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1390 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1391 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1392 return ExprError();
1393
1394 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1395 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1396 return ExprError();
1397
1398 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1399 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1400 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1401 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1402
1403 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1404 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1405 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1406 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001407 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001408 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001409 ExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
Douglas Gregore45bb6a2010-09-22 16:33:13 +00001410 SelfName, false, false);
1411 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid())
1412 return ExprError();
1413
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001414 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1415 return Owned(new (Context)
1416 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1417 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1418 }
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001419 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001420 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001421 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001422 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1423 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1424 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1425 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1426 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1427 }
1428 }
1429
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001430 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1431 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1432 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1433 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1434 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1435 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1436 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1437 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1438 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1439 }
1440 }
1441 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001442 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1443 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001444}
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001445
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001446/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1447///
1448/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1449///
1450/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1451/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1452/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1453/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1454///
1455/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1456/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1457/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1458/// the class declaring the member.
1459///
1460/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1461/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1462/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001463bool
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001464Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1465 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001466 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001467 NamedDecl *Member) {
1468 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1469 if (!RD)
1470 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001471
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001472 QualType DestRecordType;
1473 QualType DestType;
1474 QualType FromRecordType;
1475 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1476 bool PointerConversions = false;
1477 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1478 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001479
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001480 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1481 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1482 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1483 PointerConversions = true;
1484 } else {
1485 DestType = DestRecordType;
1486 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001487 }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001488 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1489 if (Method->isStatic())
1490 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001491
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001492 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1493 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001494
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001495 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1496 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1497 PointerConversions = true;
1498 } else {
1499 FromRecordType = FromType;
1500 DestType = DestRecordType;
1501 }
1502 } else {
1503 // No conversion necessary.
1504 return false;
1505 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001506
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001507 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1508 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001509
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001510 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1511 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1512 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001513
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001514 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1515 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1516
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001517 ExprValueKind VK = CastCategory(From);
Sebastian Redl906082e2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001518
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001519 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001520 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001521 // class name.
1522 //
1523 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1524 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1525 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1526 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1527 //
1528 // class Base { public: int x; };
1529 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1530 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1531 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1532 //
1533 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1534 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1535 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1536 // }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001537 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001538 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1539 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1540 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1541
1542 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1543
1544 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1545 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1546 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1547 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001548 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001549 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001550 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001551 return true;
1552
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001553 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001554 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001555 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
1556 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001557
1558 FromType = QType;
1559 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1560
1561 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1562 // we're done.
1563 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1564 return false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001565 }
1566 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001567
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001568 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001569
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001570 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1571 // down to the using declaration's type.
1572 //
1573 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1574 // class ever has member declarations.
1575 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1576 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1577 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1578 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1579
1580 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1581 // conversion is non-trivial.
1582 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1583 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001584 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001585 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001586 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001587 return true;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001588
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001589 QualType UType = URecordType;
1590 if (PointerConversions)
1591 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001592 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001593 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001594 FromType = UType;
1595 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1596 }
1597
1598 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1599 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1600 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001601 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001602
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001603 CXXCastPath BasePath;
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001604 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1605 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001606 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001607 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001608
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001609 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001610 VK, &BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001611 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001612}
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001613
Douglas Gregor83f6faf2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001614/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001615static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedmanf595cc42009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001616 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001617 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001618 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo,
1619 QualType Ty,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001620 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1621 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1622 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001623 if (SS.isSet()) {
1624 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1625 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001626 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001627
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001628 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001629 Member, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
1630 TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001631}
1632
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001633/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1634/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1635/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1636/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001637ExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001638Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1639 LookupResult &R,
1640 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1641 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001642 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1643
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001644 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001645
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001646 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1647 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregore961afb2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001648 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001649 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001650 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001651 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001652 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001653
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001654 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1655 // 'this' expression now.
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001656 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1657 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001658 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1659 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001660 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1661 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1662 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1663 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001664 }
1665
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001666 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(This, ThisType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001667 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1668 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001669 SS,
1670 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1671 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001672}
1673
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001674bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001675 const LookupResult &R,
1676 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001677 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1678 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1679 return false;
1680
1681 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001682 if (SS.isSet())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001683 return false;
1684
1685 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001686 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001687 return false;
1688
1689 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1690 // normal lookup:
1691 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1692 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1693
1694 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1695 // -- a declaration of a class member
1696 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1697 // original decl.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001698 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001699 return false;
1700
1701 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1702 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1703 // using-declaration
1704 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1705 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1706 // turn off ADL anyway).
1707 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1708 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1709 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1710 return false;
1711
1712 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1713 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1714 // template
1715 // And also for builtin functions.
1716 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1717 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1718
1719 // But also builtin functions.
1720 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1721 return false;
1722 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1723 return false;
1724 }
1725
1726 return true;
1727}
1728
1729
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001730/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1731/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1732/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1733/// will in fact be used.
1734static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1735 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1736 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1737 return true;
1738 }
1739
1740 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1741 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1742 return true;
1743 }
1744
1745 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1746 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1747 return true;
1748 }
1749
1750 return false;
1751}
1752
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001753ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001754Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001755 LookupResult &R,
1756 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCallfead20c2009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001757 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1758 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor86b8e092010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001759 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001760 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(),
1761 R.getFoundDecl());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001762
1763 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1764 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1765 // functions and function templates.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001766 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1767 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001768 return ExprError();
1769
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001770 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1771 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1772 // we've picked a target.
1773 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1774
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001775 bool Dependent
1776 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001777 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001778 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001779 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001780 SS.getRange(), R.getLookupNameInfo(),
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001781 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1782 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001783
1784 return Owned(ULE);
1785}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001786
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001787
1788/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001789ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001790Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001791 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
1792 NamedDecl *D) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001793 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall7453ed42009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001794 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1795 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001796
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001797 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001798 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1799 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001800
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001801 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1802 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1803 // a template argument list.
1804 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1805 << Template << SS.getRange();
1806 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1807 return ExprError();
1808 }
1809
1810 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1811 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1812 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001813 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001814 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCall87cf6702009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001815 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001816 return ExprError();
1817 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001818
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001819 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1820 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1821 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1822 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001823 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001824 return ExprError();
1825
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001826 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1827 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001828 return ExprError();
1829
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001830 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1831 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1832 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1833 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001834 //
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001835 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1836 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1837 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001838 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001839 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump0d6fd572010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001840 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1841 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1842 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1843 return ExprError();
1844 }
1845
Fariborz Jahanian8596bbe2010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001846 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump28497342010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001847 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1848 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1849 return ExprError();
1850 }
1851
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001852 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001853 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001854 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001855 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001856 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001857 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1858 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001859 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001860
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001861 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian52bc56a2010-07-12 17:26:57 +00001862 QualType T = VD->getType();
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001863 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1864 ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanian84ca0082010-07-12 18:12:03 +00001865 constAdded);
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001866 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1867 if (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isReferenceType()) {
1868 Expr *E = new (Context)
1869 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1870 SourceLocation());
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001871
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001872 ExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001873 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
Fariborz Jahanian310b1c42010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001874 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001875 SourceLocation(),
1876 Owned(E));
1877 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001878 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(Res.get());
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001879 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
1880 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
1881 }
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001882 }
1883 }
1884 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001885 }
1886 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1887 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001888
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001889 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
1890 NameInfo, &SS);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001891}
1892
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001893ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001894 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001895 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001896
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001897 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001898 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001899 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1900 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1901 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001902 }
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001903
Chris Lattnerfa28b302008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001904 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1905 // string.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001906
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001907 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanianeb024ac2010-07-23 21:53:24 +00001908 if (!currentDecl && getCurBlock())
1909 currentDecl = getCurBlock()->TheDecl;
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001910 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001911 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001912 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001913 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001914
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001915 QualType ResTy;
1916 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1917 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1918 } else {
Anders Carlsson848fa642010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001919 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001920
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001921 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001922 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001923 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1924 }
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001925 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001926}
1927
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001928ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001929 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001930 bool Invalid = false;
1931 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1932 if (Invalid)
1933 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001934
Benjamin Kramerddeea562010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001935 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1936 PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001937 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001938 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001939
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001940 QualType Ty;
1941 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1942 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1943 else if (Literal.isWide())
1944 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedman136b0cd2010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001945 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1946 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001947 else
1948 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001949
Sebastian Redle91b3bc2009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001950 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1951 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001952 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001953}
1954
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001955ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001956 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001957 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1958 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner7216dc92009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001959 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattner0c21e842009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001960 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00001961 return Owned(IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff0a473932009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001962 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001963 }
Ted Kremenek28396602009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001964
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001965 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattner2a299042008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001966 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1967 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001968 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001969
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001970 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001971 bool Invalid = false;
1972 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1973 if (Invalid)
1974 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001975
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001976 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001977 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
1978 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001979 return ExprError();
1980
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001981 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001982
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001983 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001984 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001985 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001986 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001987 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001988 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001989 else
Chris Lattner9e9b6dc2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001990 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001991
1992 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1993
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001994 using llvm::APFloat;
1995 APFloat Val(Format);
1996
1997 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall9f2df882009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001998
1999 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
2000 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
2001 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
2002 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002003 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002004 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002005 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002006 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002007 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
2008 } else {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002009 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002010 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
2011 }
2012
2013 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
2014 << Ty
2015 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
2016 }
2017
2018 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002019 Res = FloatingLiteral::Create(Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002020
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002021 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002022 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002023 } else {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002024 QualType Ty;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002025
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002026 // long long is a C99 feature.
2027 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth79859c32007-08-29 22:13:52 +00002028 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002029 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
2030
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002031 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002032 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002033
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002034 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
2035 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
2036 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002037 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
2038 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002039 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002040 } else {
2041 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
2042 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002043
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002044 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
2045 // be an unsigned int.
2046 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
2047
2048 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002049 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner97c51562007-08-23 21:58:08 +00002050 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
2051 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002052 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002053
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002054 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
2055 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
2056 // Does it fit in a signed int?
2057 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002058 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002059 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002060 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002061 Width = IntSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002062 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002063 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002064
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002065 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002066 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002067 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002068
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002069 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
2070 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
2071 // Does it fit in a signed long?
2072 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002073 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002074 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002075 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002076 Width = LongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002077 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002078 }
2079
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002080 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002081 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002082 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002083
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002084 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
2085 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
2086 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
2087 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002088 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002089 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002090 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002091 Width = LongLongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002092 }
2093 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002094
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002095 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
2096 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002097 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002098 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002099 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002100 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002101 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002102
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002103 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
2104 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002105 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002106 Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002107 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002108
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002109 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
2110 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002111 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002112 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002113
2114 return Owned(Res);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002115}
2116
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002117ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002118 SourceLocation R, Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002119 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002120 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002121}
2122
2123/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
2124/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002125bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002126 SourceLocation OpLoc,
2127 const SourceRange &ExprRange,
2128 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002129 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2130 return false;
2131
Sebastian Redl5d484e82009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002132 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2133 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2134 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2135 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2136 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2137 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2138
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002139 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002140 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002141 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002142 if (isSizeof)
2143 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2144 return false;
2145 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002146
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002147 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002148 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002149 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2150 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002151 return false;
2152 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002153
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002154 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002155 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2156 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002157 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002158
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002159 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002160 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002161 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattner5cb10d32009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002162 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2163 return true;
Chris Lattnerca790922009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002164 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002165
Douglas Gregor9ba6af82010-05-23 19:43:23 +00002166 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(exprType, Context.OverloadTy)) {
2167 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_overloaded_function_type)
2168 << !isSizeof << ExprRange;
2169 return true;
2170 }
2171
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002172 return false;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002173}
2174
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002175bool Sema::CheckAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2176 const SourceRange &ExprRange) {
2177 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002178
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002179 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002180 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2181 return false;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002182
2183 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2184 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2185 return false;
2186
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002187 if (E->getBitField()) {
2188 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
2189 return true;
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002190 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002191
2192 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2193 // bit-field.
2194 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump8e1fab22009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002195 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002196 return false;
2197
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002198 return CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
2199}
2200
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002201/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002202ExprResult
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002203Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002204 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002205 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002206 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002207 return ExprError();
2208
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002209 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002210
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002211 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2212 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2213 return ExprError();
2214
2215 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002216 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002217 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2218 R.getEnd()));
2219}
2220
2221/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2222/// operand.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002223ExprResult
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002224Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002225 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2226 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2227 bool isInvalid = false;
2228 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2229 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2230 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
2231 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002232 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002233 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2234 isInvalid = true;
2235 } else {
2236 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2237 }
2238
2239 if (isInvalid)
2240 return ExprError();
2241
2242 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2243 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2244 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2245 R.getEnd()));
2246}
2247
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002248/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2249/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2250/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002251ExprResult
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002252Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2253 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002254 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002255 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002256
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002257 if (isType) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002258 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00002259 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo);
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002260 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002261 }
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002262
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002263 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002264 ExprResult Result
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002265 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2266
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002267 return move(Result);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002268}
2269
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002270QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002271 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2272 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002273
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002274 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002275 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002276 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002277
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002278 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2279 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2280 return V->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002281
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002282 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002283 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2284 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002285 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002286}
2287
2288
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002289
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002290ExprResult
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002291Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002292 tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002293 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002294 switch (Kind) {
2295 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002296 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PostInc; break;
2297 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002298 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002299
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002300 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002301}
2302
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002303ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002304Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2305 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002306 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002307 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002308 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2309 Base = Result.take();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002310
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002311 Expr *LHSExp = Base, *RHSExp = Idx;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002312
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002313 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002314 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002315 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2316 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2317 }
2318
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002319 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002320 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman03f332a2008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002321 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2322 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2323 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002324 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, Base, Idx);
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002325 }
2326
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002327 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Base, LLoc, Idx, RLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002328}
2329
2330
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002331ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002332Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2333 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2334 Expr *LHSExp = Base;
2335 Expr *RHSExp = Idx;
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002336
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002337 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002338 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2339 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2340 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002341
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002342 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002343
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002344 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002345 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002346 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002347 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002348 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2349 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002350 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2351 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2352 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2353 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002354 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002355 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2356 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002357 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002358 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner7a2e0472007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002359 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002360 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2361 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002362 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002363 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002364 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002365 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2366 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2367 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002368 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002369 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002370 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2371 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2372 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2373 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002374 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattnerc8629632007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002375 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002376 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begeman334a8022009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002377
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002378 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2379 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002380 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2381 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002382 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002383 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2384 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2385 // force the promotion here.
2386 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2387 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002388 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002389 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002390 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2391
2392 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2393 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002394 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002395 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2396 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2397 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2398 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002399 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002400 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002401 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2402
2403 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2404 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002405 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002406 } else {
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002407 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2408 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002409 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002410 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00002411 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002412 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2413 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002414
Daniel Dunbar7e88a602009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002415 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinig0f9a5b52009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002416 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2417 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig76e2b712009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002418 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2419
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002420 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002421 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2422 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002423 // incomplete types are not object types.
2424 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2425 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2426 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2427 return ExprError();
2428 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002429
Abramo Bagnara46358452010-09-13 06:50:07 +00002430 if (ResultType->isVoidType() && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
2431 // GNU extension: subscripting on pointer to void
2432 Diag(LLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
2433 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2434 } else if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002435 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002436 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2437 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002438 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002439
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002440 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002441 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002442 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2443 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2444 return ExprError();
2445 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002446
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002447 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002448 ResultType, RLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002449}
2450
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002451QualType Sema::
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002452CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002453 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002454 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbar2ad32892009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002455 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2456 // see FIXME there.
2457 //
2458 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2459 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002460 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002461
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002462 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002463 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002464
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002465 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002466 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2467 // to be selected.
2468 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002469
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002470 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2471 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman131f4652009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002472 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002473
2474 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2475 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002476 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002477 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2478 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002479 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002480 do
2481 compStr++;
2482 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002483 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002484 do
2485 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002486 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002487 }
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002488
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002489 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002490 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2491 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002492 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
Benjamin Kramer476d8b82010-08-11 14:47:12 +00002493 << llvm::StringRef(compStr, 1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002494 return QualType();
2495 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002496
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002497 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2498 // operates on.
2499 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002500 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002501
2502 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002503 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002504
2505 while (*compStr) {
2506 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2507 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2508 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2509 return QualType();
2510 }
2511 }
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002512 }
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002513
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002514 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002515 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002516 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002517 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002518 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begeman0479a0b2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002519 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002520 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002521 if (HexSwizzle)
2522 CompSize--;
2523
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002524 if (CompSize == 1)
2525 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002526
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002527 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002528 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002529 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2530 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2531 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2532 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffbea0b342007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002533 }
2534 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002535}
2536
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002537static Decl *FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002538 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002539 const Selector &Sel,
2540 ASTContext &Context) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002541
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002542 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002543 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002544 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002545 return OMD;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002546
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002547 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2548 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002549 if (Decl *D = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002550 Context))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002551 return D;
2552 }
2553 return 0;
2554}
2555
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002556static Decl *FindGetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002557 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002558 const Selector &Sel,
2559 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002560 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2561 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002562 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002563 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002564 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002565 GDecl = PD;
2566 break;
2567 }
2568 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002569 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002570 GDecl = OMD;
2571 break;
2572 }
2573 }
2574 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002575 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002576 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2577 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002578 GDecl = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel, Context);
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002579 if (GDecl)
2580 return GDecl;
2581 }
2582 }
2583 return GDecl;
2584}
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002585
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002586ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002587Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002588 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002589 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2590 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002591 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002592 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002593 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2594 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2595 //
2596 // T* t;
2597 // t.f;
2598 //
2599 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2600 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2601 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2602 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002603 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002604 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2605 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002606 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002607 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002608 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002609 return ExprError();
2610 }
2611 }
2612
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002613 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2614 NameInfo.getName().isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002615 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002616
2617 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2618 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002619 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002620 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002621 SS.getScopeRep(),
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002622 SS.getRange(),
2623 FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002624 NameInfo, TemplateArgs));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002625}
2626
2627/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2628/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2629/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2630static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2631 Expr *BaseExpr,
2632 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002633 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002634 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002635 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2636 // diagnostics.
2637 if (!BaseExpr)
2638 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002639
John McCall110acc12010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002640 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2641 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002642}
2643
2644// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2645// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2646// type. The restriction here is:
2647//
2648// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2649// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2650// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2651//
2652// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2653// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2654// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2655// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2656bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2657 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002658 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002659 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002660 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2661 if (!BaseRT) {
2662 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2663 // dependent.
2664 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2665 return false;
2666 }
2667 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002668
2669 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002670 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2671 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002672 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002673 return false;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002674
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002675 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
Eli Friedman02463762010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002676 DeclContext *DC = (*I)->getDeclContext();
2677 while (DC->isTransparentContext())
2678 DC = DC->getParent();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002679
Douglas Gregor9d4bb942010-07-28 22:27:52 +00002680 if (!DC->isRecord())
2681 continue;
2682
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002683 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
Eli Friedman02463762010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002684 MemberRecord.insert(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getCanonicalDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002685
2686 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2687 return false;
2688 }
2689
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002690 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002691 return true;
2692}
2693
2694static bool
2695LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2696 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002697 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2698 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002699 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2700 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002701 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002702 << BaseRange))
2703 return true;
2704
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002705 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
2706 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
2707 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
2708
2709 bool MOUS;
2710 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
2711 return false;
2712 }
2713
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002714 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2715 if (SS.isSet()) {
2716 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2717 // nested-name-specifier.
2718 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2719
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002720 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002721 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2722 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2723 return true;
2724 }
2725
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002726 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002727
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002728 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2729 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2730 << DC << SS.getRange();
2731 return true;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002732 }
2733 }
2734
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002735 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2736 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002737
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002738 if (!R.empty())
2739 return false;
2740
2741 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2742 // for typos.
2743 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002744 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002745 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002746 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2747 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2748 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002749 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2750 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002751 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2752 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2753 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002754 return false;
2755 } else {
2756 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor12eb5d62010-06-29 19:27:42 +00002757 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002758 }
2759
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002760 return false;
2761}
2762
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002763ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002764Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *Base, QualType BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002765 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002766 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002767 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002768 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002769 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002770 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2771 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002772 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002773 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2774 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002775 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002776
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002777 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002778
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002779 // Implicit member accesses.
2780 if (!Base) {
2781 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2782 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2783 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2784 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002785 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002786 return ExprError();
2787
2788 // Explicit member accesses.
2789 } else {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002790 ExprResult Result =
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002791 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00002792 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ 0, TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002793
2794 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2795 Owned(Base);
2796 return ExprError();
2797 }
2798
2799 if (Result.get())
2800 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlf3e63372010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002801
2802 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2803 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002804 }
2805
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002806 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002807 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2808 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002809}
2810
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002811ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002812Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseExprType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002813 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2814 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002815 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002816 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002817 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2818 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002819 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002820 if (IsArrow) {
2821 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2822 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2823 }
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002824 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002825
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002826 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = SS.getScopeRep();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002827 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo = R.getLookupNameInfo();
2828 DeclarationName MemberName = MemberNameInfo.getName();
2829 SourceLocation MemberLoc = MemberNameInfo.getLoc();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002830
2831 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002832 return ExprError();
2833
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002834 if (R.empty()) {
2835 // Rederive where we looked up.
2836 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2837 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2838 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002839
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002840 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002841 << MemberName << DC
2842 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002843 return ExprError();
2844 }
2845
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002846 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2847 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2848 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2849 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2850 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2851 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2852 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2853 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2854 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2855 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002856 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002857 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002858 return ExprError();
2859
2860 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2861 // result.
2862 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002863 bool Dependent =
John McCall410a3f32009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002864 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002865 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002866 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002867
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002868 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2869 // pick a member.
2870 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2871
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002872 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2873 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2874 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002875 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2876 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002877 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002878 MemberNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002879 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002880
2881 return Owned(MemExpr);
2882 }
2883
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002884 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002885 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002886 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2887
2888 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2889
2890 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2891 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2892 // error cases.
2893 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2894 return ExprError();
2895
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002896 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2897 if (!BaseExpr) {
2898 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002899 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002900 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), MemberDecl);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002901
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002902 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2903 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2904 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2905 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002906 }
2907
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002908 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2909 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2910 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2911 // explicitly qualified.
2912 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2913 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2914 }
2915
2916 // Check the use of this member.
2917 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2918 Owned(BaseExpr);
2919 return ExprError();
2920 }
2921
2922 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2923 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2924 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman16c53782009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002925 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2926 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002927 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2928 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2929
2930 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2931 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2932 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2933 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2934 else {
2935 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2936 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2937 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2938
2939 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2940 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2941
2942 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2943 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2944 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2945 }
2946
2947 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002948 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002949 return ExprError();
2950 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002951 FD, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2952 MemberType));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002953 }
2954
2955 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2956 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2957 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002958 Var, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002959 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2960 }
2961
2962 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2963 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2964 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002965 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002966 MemberFn->getType()));
2967 }
2968
2969 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2970 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2971 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002972 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2973 Enum->getType()));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002974 }
2975
2976 Owned(BaseExpr);
2977
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002978 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002979 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002980 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002981 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
2982 else
2983 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2984 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002985
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002986 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
2987 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00002988 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002989 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002990}
2991
2992/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2993/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2994/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2995/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2996/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2997/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2998/// an ordinary member expression.
2999///
3000/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
3001/// fixed for ObjC++.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003002ExprResult
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003003Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003004 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003005 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003006 Decl *ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003007 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003008
Steve Naroff3cc4af82007-12-16 21:42:28 +00003009 // Perform default conversions.
3010 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003011
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003012 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003013 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
3014
3015 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
3016 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003017
3018 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003019 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003020 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
3021 // call, and continue on.
3022 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3023 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
3024 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
3025 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
3026 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003027 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
3028 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003029 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
3030 ->isRecordType()))) {
3031 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
3032 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
3033 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003034 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003035
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003036 ExprResult NewBase
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003037 = ActOnCallExpr(0, BaseExpr, Loc, MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), Loc);
Douglas Gregorf918b832010-06-21 22:46:46 +00003038 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003039 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003040 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003041
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003042 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
3043 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
3044 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
3045 }
3046 }
3047 }
3048
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003049 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3050 // use that.
3051 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003052 if (IsArrow) {
3053 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
3054 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3055 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003056 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003057 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003058 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
3059 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003060 }
3061 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003062 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3063 // is a reference to 'isa'.
3064 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
3065 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003066 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003067 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003068 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003069
Fariborz Jahanian369a3bd2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003070 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3071 // use that.
3072 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
3073 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3074 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
3075 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
3076 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003077 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian369a3bd2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003078 }
3079 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003080
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003081 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003082
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003083 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003084 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003085 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
3086 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3087 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
3088 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
3089 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
3090 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
3091 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
3092 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
3093 // Check the use of this method.
3094 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
3095 return ExprError();
3096 }
3097 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
3098 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
3099 Selector SetterSel =
3100 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3101 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3102 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
3103 if (!Setter) {
3104 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
3105 // methods.
Steve Naroffd789d3d2009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003106 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003107 }
3108 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
3109 if (!Setter)
3110 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003111
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003112 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3113 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003114
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003115 if (Getter || Setter) {
3116 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003117
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003118 if (Getter)
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003119 PType = Getter->getSendResultType();
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003120 else
3121 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3122 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3123 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003124 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003125 PType,
3126 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3127 }
3128 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3129 << MemberName << BaseType);
3130 }
3131 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003132
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003133 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3134 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3135 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003136 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003137 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003138
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003139 if (IsArrow) {
3140 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003141 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003142 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3143 ;
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003144 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3145 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3146 // struct MyRecord foo;
3147 // foo->bar
3148 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3149 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3150 // by now.
3151 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3152 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003153 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003154 IsArrow = false;
3155 } else {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003156 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3157 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3158 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson4ef27702009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003159 }
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003160 } else {
3161 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3162 // type *foo;
3163 // foo.bar
3164 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3165 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3166 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3167 // the appropriate pointer type
3168 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3169 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3170 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3171 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3172 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003173 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003174 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3175 IsArrow = true;
3176 }
3177 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003178 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003179
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003180 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003181 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003182 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003183 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003184 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003185 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003186 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003187
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003188 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3189 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003190 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003191 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003192 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003193 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3194 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3195 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3196 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003197 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3198
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003199 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003200 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003201
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003202 if (!IV) {
3203 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3204 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3205 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003206 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003207 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003208 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003209 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3210 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003211 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3212 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003213 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003214 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor12eb5d62010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003215 } else {
3216 Res.clear();
3217 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003218 }
3219 }
3220
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003221 if (IV) {
3222 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3223 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3224 // error cases.
3225 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3226 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003227
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003228 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3229 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3230 return ExprError();
3231 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3232 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3233 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3234 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3235 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3236 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3237 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3238 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3239 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3240 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3241 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3242 // AST for a function decl.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003243 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003244 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003245 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3246 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003247 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003248 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3249 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003250
3251 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3252 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003253 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003254 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003255 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003256 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3257 // @protected
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003258 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003259 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffb06d8752009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003260 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003261
3262 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3263 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003264 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahanian935fd762009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003265 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003266 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003267 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003268 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianaaa63a72008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003269 }
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003270 }
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003271 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003272 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3273 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003274 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003275 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003276
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003277 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003278 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003279 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3280 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3281 // Check the use of this declaration
3282 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3283 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003284
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003285 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3286 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3287 }
3288 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3289 // Check the use of this method.
3290 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3291 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanianed76f442010-10-07 18:12:21 +00003292 // It is important that start and end position is the first character
3293 // and last character position of the property-dot syntax expression.
3294 SourceLocation MemberEndLoc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(MemberLoc, 1);
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003295 return Owned(ObjCMessageExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003296 OMD->getSendResultType(),
Fariborz Jahanianed76f442010-10-07 18:12:21 +00003297 BaseExpr->getExprLoc(),
3298 BaseExpr, Sel,
3299 OMD, NULL, 0, MemberEndLoc));
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003300 }
3301 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003302
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003303 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003304 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003305 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003306
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003307 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3308 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner7f816522010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003309 if (!IsArrow)
3310 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3311 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattnerb9d4fc12010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003312 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003313
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003314 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003315 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003316 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3317 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003318 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003319 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003320 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003321
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003322 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner73525de2009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003323 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003324 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003325 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3326 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003327 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003328 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003329 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003330 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003331
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003332 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3333 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3334
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003335 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003336}
3337
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003338/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3339/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3340/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3341/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3342/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3343///
3344/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3345/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3346/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3347/// only be called
3348/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3349/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3350/// aren't properly put in the context chain
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003351ExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003352 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3353 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003354 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003355 UnqualifiedId &Id,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003356 Decl *ObjCImpDecl,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003357 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3358 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3359 return ExprError();
3360
3361 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3362
3363 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003364 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003365 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3366 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003367 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003368
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003369 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003370 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3371
3372 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3373 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3374 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3375
3376 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003377 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003378 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3379 Base = Result.take();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003380
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003381 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3382 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003383 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003384 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3385 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003386 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003387 } else {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003388 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003389 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3390 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003391
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003392 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3393 Owned(Base);
3394 return ExprError();
3395 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003396
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003397 if (Result.get()) {
3398 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3399 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3400 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3401 // call now.
3402 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3403 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003404 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameInfo.getLoc(), Result.get());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003405
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003406 return move(Result);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003407 }
3408
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003409 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003410 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3411 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003412 }
3413
3414 return move(Result);
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003415}
3416
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003417ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003418 FunctionDecl *FD,
3419 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3420 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003421 Diag(CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003422 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3423 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003424 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003425 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003426 return ExprError();
3427 }
3428
3429 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3430 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003431
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003432 // Instantiate the expression.
3433 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3434 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson25cae7f2009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003435
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003436 std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> Innermost
3437 = ArgList.getInnermost();
3438 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, Innermost.first,
3439 Innermost.second);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003440
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003441 ExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
3442 if (Result.isInvalid())
3443 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003444
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003445 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3446 InitializedEntity Entity
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003447 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003448 InitializationKind Kind
3449 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3450 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3451 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003452
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003453 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
3454 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3455 MultiExprArg(*this, &ResultE, 1));
3456 if (Result.isInvalid())
3457 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003458
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003459 // Build the default argument expression.
3460 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
3461 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003462 }
3463
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003464 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3465 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3466 // be properly destroyed.
3467 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3468 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Douglas Gregor5833b0b2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00003469 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i) {
3470 CXXTemporary *Temporary = Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i);
3471 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Param->getDefaultArg()->getLocStart(),
3472 const_cast<CXXDestructorDecl*>(Temporary->getDestructor()));
3473 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Temporary);
3474 }
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003475
3476 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00003477 // Just mark all of the declarations in this potentially-evaluated expression
3478 // as being "referenced".
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003479 MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Param->getDefaultArg());
Douglas Gregor036aed12009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003480 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003481}
3482
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003483/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3484/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3485/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3486/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3487/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3488/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003489bool
3490Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003491 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003492 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003493 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3494 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003495 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003496 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3497 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003498 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003499
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003500 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3501 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3502 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3503 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3504 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003505 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherd77b9a22010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003506 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003507 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003508 }
3509
3510 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3511 // them.
3512 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3513 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3514 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3515 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003516 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherccfa9632010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003517 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003518 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3519 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3520 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003521 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003522 return true;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003523 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003524 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003525 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003526 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003527 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3528 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3529 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3530 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3531 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003532 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian2fe168f2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003533 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003534 if (Invalid)
3535 return true;
3536 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3537 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3538 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003539
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003540 return false;
3541}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003542
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003543bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3544 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3545 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3546 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3547 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3548 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003549 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003550 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3551 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3552 bool Invalid = false;
3553 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3554 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3555 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3556 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003557 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003558 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003559 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003560
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003561 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003562 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3563 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003564
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003565 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3566 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003567 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003568 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003569 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003570
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003571 // Pass the argument
3572 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3573 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3574 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregoraa037312009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003575
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003576 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003577 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param)
3578 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, ProtoArgType);
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003579 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003580 SourceLocation(),
3581 Owned(Arg));
3582 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3583 return true;
3584
3585 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003586 } else {
Anders Carlssoned961f92009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003587 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003588
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003589 ExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003590 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003591 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3592 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003593
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003594 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003595 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003596 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003597 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003598
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003599 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003600 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003601 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003602 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003603 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003604 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003605 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003606 }
3607 }
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003608 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003609}
3610
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003611/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003612/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3613/// locations.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003614ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003615Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003616 MultiExprArg args, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003617 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003618
3619 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003620 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Fn);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003621 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3622 Fn = Result.take();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003623
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003624 Expr **Args = args.release();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003625
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003626 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003627 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3628 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3629 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3630 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3631 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003632 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003633 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3634 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003635
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003636 NumArgs = 0;
3637 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003638
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003639 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3640 RParenLoc));
3641 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003642
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003643 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003644 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003645 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3646 // Fn.
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003647 bool Dependent = false;
3648 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3649 Dependent = true;
3650 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3651 Dependent = true;
3652
3653 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003654 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003655 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3656
3657 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3658 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3659 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003660 RParenLoc));
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003661
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003662 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3663
3664 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3665 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3666 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3667 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3668 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3669 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3670 // method template.
3671 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003672 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3673 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor958aeb02009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003674 (void)MemE;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003675
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003676 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003677 RParenLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003678 }
3679
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003680 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003681 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003682 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003683 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003684 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003685 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003686 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003687
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003688 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003689 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003690 if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD ||
3691 BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregor5f970ee2010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003692 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3693 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003694 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getCallResultType(Context);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003695
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003696 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall
3697 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
3698 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3699 RParenLoc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003700
3701 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3702 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003703 TheCall, 0))
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003704 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8d6d90d2009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003705
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003706 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003707 RParenLoc))
3708 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003709
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003710 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003711 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003712 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003713 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3714 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003715 }
3716 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003717 }
3718
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003719 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003720 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor6db8ed42009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003721 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003722
Eli Friedmanefa42f72009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003723 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003724 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3725 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor1aae80b2010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003726 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003727 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003728 }
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003729
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003730 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3731 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3732 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3733
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003734 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3735}
3736
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003737/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3738/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003739/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3740/// block-pointer type.
3741///
3742/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003743ExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003744Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3745 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3746 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3747 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3748 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3749
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003750 // Promote the function operand.
3751 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3752
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003753 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3754 // of arguments and function on error.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003755 CallExpr *TheCall = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3756 Args, NumArgs,
3757 Context.BoolTy,
3758 RParenLoc);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003759
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003760 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3761 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3762 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3763 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003764 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003765 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003766 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3767 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003768 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003769 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003770 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003771 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003772 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003773 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003774 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3775 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3776
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003777 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003778 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003779 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall,
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003780 FDecl))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003781 return ExprError();
3782
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003783 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003784 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003785
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003786 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003787 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003788 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003789 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003790 } else {
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003791 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003792
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003793 if (FDecl) {
3794 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3795 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3796 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis06a54a32010-07-07 11:31:19 +00003797 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003798 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003799 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003800 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3801 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3802 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3803 }
3804 }
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003805 }
3806
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003807 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003808 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3809 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3810 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003811 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3812 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003813 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3814 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003815 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003816 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003817 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003818 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003819
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003820 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3821 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003822 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3823 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003824
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003825 // Check for sentinels
3826 if (NDecl)
3827 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003828
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003829 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003830 if (FDecl) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003831 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003832 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003833
Douglas Gregor7814e6d2009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003834 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003835 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall);
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003836 } else if (NDecl) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003837 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003838 return ExprError();
3839 }
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003840
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003841 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003842}
3843
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003844ExprResult
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00003845Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003846 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) {
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003847 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroffaff1edd2007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003848 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003849 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003850
3851 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3852 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3853 if (!TInfo)
3854 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3855
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003856 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003857}
3858
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003859ExprResult
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003860Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003861 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *literalExpr) {
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003862 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Anders Carlssond35c8322007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003863
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003864 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003865 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003866 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3867 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor690dc7f2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003868 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3869 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003870 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003871 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003872 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003873 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003874
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003875 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregord6542d82009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003876 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003877 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003878 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003879 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003880 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003881 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
John McCallca0408f2010-08-23 06:44:23 +00003882 MultiExprArg(*this, &literalExpr, 1),
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003883 &literalType);
3884 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003885 return ExprError();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003886 literalExpr = Result.get();
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003887
Chris Lattner371f2582008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003888 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003889 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003890 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003891 return ExprError();
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003892 }
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003893
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003894 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003895 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003896}
3897
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003898ExprResult
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003899Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003900 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3901 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003902 Expr **InitList = initlist.release();
Anders Carlsson66b5a8a2007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003903
Steve Naroff08d92e42007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003904 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003905 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003906
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003907 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3908 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003909 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003910 return Owned(E);
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003911}
3912
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003913static CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003914 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003915 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003916 return CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003917
3918 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3919 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003920 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003921 CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
3922 CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003923 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003924 return CK_PointerToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003925 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003926
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003927 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3928 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003929 return CK_IntegralCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003930 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003931 return CK_IntegralToPointer;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003932 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003933 return CK_IntegralToFloating;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003934 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003935
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003936 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3937 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003938 return CK_FloatingCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003939 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003940 return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003941 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003942
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003943 // FIXME: Assert here.
3944 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003945 return CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003946}
3947
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003948/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redlef0cb8e2009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003949bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003950 CastKind& Kind,
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00003951 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahaniane9f42082009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003952 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003953 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003954 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3955 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003956
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003957 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003958
3959 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3960 // type needs to be scalar.
3961 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3962 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003963 Kind = CK_ToVoid;
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003964 return false;
3965 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003966
Eli Friedman8d438082010-07-17 20:43:49 +00003967 if (RequireCompleteType(TyR.getBegin(), castType,
3968 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete))
3969 return true;
3970
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003971 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003972 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003973 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3974 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003975 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003976 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3977 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003978 Kind = CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003979 return false;
3980 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003981
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003982 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003983 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003984 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003985 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003986 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003987 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003988 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003989 castExpr->getType())) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003990 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3991 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3992 break;
3993 }
3994 }
3995 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3996 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
3997 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003998 Kind = CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003999 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004000 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004001
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004002 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
4003 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4004 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4005 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004006
4007 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004008 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004009 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4010 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004011 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004012 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004013
4014 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004015 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004016
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004017 if (castType->isVectorType())
4018 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
4019 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
4020 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
4021
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004022 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
4023 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004024
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004025 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004026 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004027 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor2ade35e2010-06-16 00:17:44 +00004028 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004029 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4030 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
4031 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4032 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004033 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004034 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4035 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
4036 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004037 }
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004038
4039 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
John McCallb7f4ffe2010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004040
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004041 if (Kind == CK_Unknown || Kind == CK_BitCast)
John McCallb7f4ffe2010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004042 CheckCastAlign(castExpr, castType, TyR);
4043
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004044 return false;
4045}
4046
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004047bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004048 CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004049 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004050
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004051 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00004052 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004053 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004054 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004055 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004056 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004057 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004058 } else
4059 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004060 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004061 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004062
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004063 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004064 return false;
4065}
4066
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004067bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004068 CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004069 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004070
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004071 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004072
Nate Begeman9b10da62009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004073 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4074 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004075 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
4076 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4077 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
4078 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004079 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004080 return false;
4081 }
4082
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004083 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004084 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4085 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004086 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4087 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4088 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4089 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004090
4091 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
4092 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
4093 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004094
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004095 Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004096 return false;
4097}
4098
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004099ExprResult
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004100Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004101 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
4102 assert((Ty != 0) && (castExpr != 0) &&
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004103 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff16beff82007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004104
John McCall9d125032010-01-15 18:39:57 +00004105 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
4106 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
4107 if (!castTInfo)
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004108 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004109
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004110 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
4111 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004112 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, castExpr,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004113 castTInfo);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004114
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004115 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, castExpr);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004116}
4117
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004118ExprResult
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004119Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004120 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004121 CastKind Kind = CK_Unknown;
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004122 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004123 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004124 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004125 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson0aebc812009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004126
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004127 return Owned(CStyleCastExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004128 Ty->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004129 Kind, castExpr, &BasePath, Ty,
4130 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004131}
4132
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004133/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4134/// of comma binary operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004135ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004136Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *expr) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004137 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4138 if (!E)
4139 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004140
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004141 ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004142
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004143 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004144 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(),
4145 E->getExpr(i));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004146
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004147 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4148
4149 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004150}
4151
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004152ExprResult
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004153Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004154 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *Op,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004155 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004156 ParenListExpr *PE = cast<ParenListExpr>(Op);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004157 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004158 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004159
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004160 // Check for an altivec literal,
4161 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004162 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4163 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4164 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4165 return ExprError();
4166 }
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004167 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4168 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4169 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4170 }
4171 else
4172 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4173 }
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004174
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004175 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4176 // then handle it as such.
4177 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004178 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4179 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4180 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4181
4182 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4183 // braces instead of the original commas.
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004184 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4185 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004186 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4187 E->setType(Ty);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004188 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, E);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004189 } else {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004190 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004191 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004192 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Op);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004193 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4194 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Result.take());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004195 }
4196}
4197
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004198ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004199 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004200 MultiExprArg Val,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004201 ParsedType TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004202 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4203 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004204 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4205 Expr *expr;
4206 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4207 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4208 else
4209 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004210 return Owned(expr);
4211}
4212
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004213/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4214/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004215/// C99 6.5.15
4216QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004217 Expr *&SAVE,
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004218 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004219 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4220 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004221 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, SAVE, QuestionLoc);
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004222
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004223 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004224 if (SAVE) {
4225 SAVE = LHS = Cond;
4226 }
4227 else
4228 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004229 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4230 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4231 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4232 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004233
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004234 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004235 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
Nate Begeman6155d732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004236 // OpenCL: Sec 6.3.i says the condition is allowed to be a vector or scalar.
4237 // Throw an error if its not either.
4238 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL) {
4239 if (!CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4240 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(),
4241 diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar_or_vector)
4242 << CondTy;
4243 return QualType();
4244 }
4245 }
4246 else {
4247 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4248 << CondTy;
4249 return QualType();
4250 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004251 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004252
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004253 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004254 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4255 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004256
Nate Begeman6155d732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004257 // OpenCL: If the condition is a vector, and both operands are scalar,
4258 // attempt to implicity convert them to the vector type to act like the
4259 // built in select.
4260 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL && CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4261 // Both operands should be of scalar type.
4262 if (!LHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4263 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4264 << CondTy;
4265 return QualType();
4266 }
4267 if (!RHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4268 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4269 << CondTy;
4270 return QualType();
4271 }
4272 // Implicity convert these scalars to the type of the condition.
4273 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4274 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4275 }
4276
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004277 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4278 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004279 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4280 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4281 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffa4332e22007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004282 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004283
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004284 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4285 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004286 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4287 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004288 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004289 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004290 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004291 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004292 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004293 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004294
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004295 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004296 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004297 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4298 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4299 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4300 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4301 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4302 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4303 << LHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004304 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
4305 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman0e724012008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004306 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004307 }
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004308 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4309 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004310 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004311 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004312 // promote the null to a pointer.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004313 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004314 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004315 }
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004316 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004317 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004318 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004319 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004320 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004321
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004322 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4323 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4324 QuestionLoc);
4325 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4326 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004327
4328
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004329 // Handle block pointer types.
4330 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4331 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4332 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4333 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004334 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
4335 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004336 return destType;
4337 }
4338 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004339 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004340 return QualType();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004341 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004342 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4343 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4344 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004345 return LHSTy;
4346 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004347 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004348 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4349 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004350
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004351 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4352 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004353 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004354 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004355 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4356 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4357 // to get a consistent AST.
4358 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004359 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4360 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004361 return incompatTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004362 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004363 // The block pointer types are compatible.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004364 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4365 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff91588042009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004366 return LHSTy;
4367 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004368
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004369 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4370 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4371 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004372 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4373 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004374
4375 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4376 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4377 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004378 QualType destPointee
4379 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004380 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004381 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004382 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004383 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004384 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004385 return destType;
4386 }
4387 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004388 QualType destPointee
4389 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004390 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004391 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004392 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004393 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004394 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004395 return destType;
4396 }
4397
4398 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4399 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4400 return LHSTy;
4401 }
4402 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4403 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4404 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4405 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4406 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4407 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4408 // to get a consistent AST.
4409 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004410 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4411 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004412 return incompatTy;
4413 }
4414 // The pointer types are compatible.
4415 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4416 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4417 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4418 // type.
4419 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4420 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004421 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4422 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004423 return LHSTy;
4424 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004425
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004426 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4427 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4428 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4429 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004430 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004431 return RHSTy;
4432 }
4433 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4434 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4435 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004436 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004437 return LHSTy;
4438 }
Daniel Dunbar5e155f02008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004439
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004440 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004441 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4442 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004443 return QualType();
4444}
4445
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004446/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4447/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4448QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4449 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4450 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4451 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004452
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004453 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4454 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4455 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4456 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4457 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004458 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004459 return LHSTy;
4460 }
4461 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4462 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004463 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004464 return RHSTy;
4465 }
4466 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4467 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4468 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004469 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004470 return LHSTy;
4471 }
4472 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4473 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004474 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004475 return RHSTy;
4476 }
4477 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4478 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4479 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004480 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004481 return LHSTy;
4482 }
4483 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4484 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004485 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004486 return RHSTy;
4487 }
4488 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4489 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004490
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004491 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4492 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4493 return LHSTy;
4494 }
4495 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4496 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4497 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004498
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004499 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4500 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4501 // type. This allows
4502 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4503 // where B is a subclass of A.
4504 //
4505 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4506 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4507 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4508 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004509
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004510 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4511 // It could return the composite type.
4512 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4513 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4514 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4515 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4516 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4517 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4518 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4519 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4520 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4521 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4522 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4523 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4524 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4525 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004526 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004527 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4528 ;
4529 else {
4530 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4531 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4532 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4533 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004534 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4535 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004536 return incompatTy;
4537 }
4538 // The object pointer types are compatible.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004539 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
4540 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004541 return compositeType;
4542 }
4543 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4544 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4545 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4546 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4547 QualType destPointee
4548 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4549 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4550 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004551 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004552 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004553 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004554 return destType;
4555 }
4556 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4557 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4558 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4559 QualType destPointee
4560 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4561 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4562 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004563 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004564 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004565 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004566 return destType;
4567 }
4568 return QualType();
4569}
4570
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004571/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004572/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004573ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004574 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004575 Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr,
4576 Expr *RHSExpr) {
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004577 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4578 // was the condition.
4579 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
Fariborz Jahanianf9b949f2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004580 Expr *SAVEExpr = 0;
4581 if (isLHSNull) {
4582 LHSExpr = SAVEExpr = CondExpr;
4583 }
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004584
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004585 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
4586 SAVEExpr, QuestionLoc);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004587 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004588 return ExprError();
4589
Douglas Gregor47e1f7c2009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004590 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Fariborz Jahanianf9b949f2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004591 LHSExpr, ColonLoc,
4592 RHSExpr, SAVEExpr,
4593 result));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004594}
4595
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004596// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004597// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004598// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4599// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4600// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004601Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004602Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
4603 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004604
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004605 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4606 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4607 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4608 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4609 return Compatible;
4610 }
4611
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004612 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004613 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4614 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004615
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004616 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004617 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4618 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004619
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004620 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004621
4622 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4623 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4624 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianf11284a2009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004625 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004626 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004627 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004628
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004629 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4630 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004631 // version of void...
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004632 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004633 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004634 return ConvTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004635
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004636 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004637 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4638 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004639 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004640
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004641 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004642 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004643 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004644
4645 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004646 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4647 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004648 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004649 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004650 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004651 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4652 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4653 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4654 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4655 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4656 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004657 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004658 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004659 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004660 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004661
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004662 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004663 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004664 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004665 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004666
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004667 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4668 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4669 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4670 // warning can be disabled.
4671 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4672 return ConvTy;
4673 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4674 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004675
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004676 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4677 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4678 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4679 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4680 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4681 do {
4682 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4683 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004684
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004685 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4686 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4687 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004688
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004689 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004690 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004691 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004692
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004693 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004694 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004695 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004696 return ConvTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004697}
4698
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004699/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4700/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4701/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4702// types.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004703Sema::AssignConvertType
4704Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004705 QualType rhsType) {
4706 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004707
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004708 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004709 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4710 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004711
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004712 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4713 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4714 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004715
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004716 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004717
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004718 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004719 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004720 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004721
Fariborz Jahanian132f2a22010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004722 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4723 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4724 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4725 }
4726 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004727 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004728 return ConvTy;
4729}
4730
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004731/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4732/// for assignment compatibility.
4733Sema::AssignConvertType
4734Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004735 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4736 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004737 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4738 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004739 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004740 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004741 }
4742 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4743 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004744 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4745 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004746 return IncompatiblePointer;
4747 return Compatible;
4748 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004749 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004750 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004751 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004752 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4753 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4754 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4755 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4756 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4757 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004758
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004759 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4760 return Compatible;
4761 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4762 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004763 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004764}
4765
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004766/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4767/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004768/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4769///
4770/// int a, *pint;
4771/// short *pshort;
4772/// struct foo *pfoo;
4773///
4774/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4775/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4776/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4777/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4778///
4779/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004780/// C99 spec dictates.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004781///
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004782Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004783Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004784 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4785 // them.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004786 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4787 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004788
4789 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerd2656dd2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004790 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff700204c2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004791
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004792 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4793 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4794 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4795 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4796 return Compatible;
4797 }
4798
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004799 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4800 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4801 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4802 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4803 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4804 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4805 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004806 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004807 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson793680e2007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004808 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004809 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahanian411f3732007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004810 }
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004811 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4812 // to the same ExtVector type.
4813 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4814 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4815 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00004816 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004817 return Compatible;
4818 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004819
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004820 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004821 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
4822 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
4823 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
4824 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
4825 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4826 (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)))
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004827 return IncompatibleVectors;
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004828
4829 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
4830 // vector type and vice versa
4831 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType))
4832 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnere8b3e962008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004833 }
4834 return Incompatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004835 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004836
Douglas Gregor88623ad2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004837 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4838 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004839 return Compatible;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004840
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004841 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004842 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004843 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004844
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004845 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004846 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004847
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004848 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004849 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004850 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4851 return Compatible;
4852 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004853 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004854 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4855 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004856 return Compatible;
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004857
4858 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004859 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004860 return Compatible;
4861 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004862 return Incompatible;
4863 }
4864
4865 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4866 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedmand8f4f432009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004867 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004868
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004869 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004870 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004871 return Compatible;
4872
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004873 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4874 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004875
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004876 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004877 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004878 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004879 }
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004880 return Incompatible;
4881 }
4882
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004883 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4884 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4885 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004886
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004887 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004888 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004889 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4890 return Compatible;
4891 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004892 }
4893 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004894 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004895 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004896 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004897 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4898 return Compatible;
4899 }
4900 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4901 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4902 return Compatible;
4903 return Incompatible;
4904 }
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004905 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004906 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004907 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4908 return Compatible;
4909
4910 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004911 return PointerToInt;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004912
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004913 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004914 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004915
4916 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004917 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004918 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004919 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004920 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004921 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4922 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4923 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4924 return Compatible;
4925
4926 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4927 return PointerToInt;
4928
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004929 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004930 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004931 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4932 return Compatible;
4933 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004934 }
4935 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004936 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004937 return Compatible;
4938 return Incompatible;
4939 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004940
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004941 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004942 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004943 return Compatible;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004944 }
4945 return Incompatible;
4946}
4947
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004948/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4949/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004950static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004951 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4952 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4953 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004954 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenekba7bc552010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004955 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004956 SourceLocation());
4957 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4958 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4959
4960 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4961 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004962 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004963 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004964 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004965}
4966
4967Sema::AssignConvertType
4968Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4969 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4970
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004971 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004972 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4973 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004974 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004975 return Incompatible;
4976
4977 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4978 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4979 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4980 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004981 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4982 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004983 it != itend; ++it) {
4984 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4985 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4986 // 1) void pointer
4987 // 2) null pointer constant
4988 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004989 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004990 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004991 InitField = *it;
4992 break;
4993 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004994
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004995 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004996 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004997 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004998 InitField = *it;
4999 break;
5000 }
5001 }
5002
5003 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
5004 == Compatible) {
Daniel Dunbar41e11a92010-09-17 23:21:43 +00005005 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005006 InitField = *it;
5007 break;
5008 }
5009 }
5010
5011 if (!InitField)
5012 return Incompatible;
5013
5014 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
5015 return Compatible;
5016}
5017
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005018Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005019Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005020 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5021 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
5022 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
5023 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
5024 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00005025 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005026 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005027 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner2c4463f2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00005028 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005029 }
5030
5031 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
5032 // structures.
5033 }
5034
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005035 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
5036 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005037 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
5038 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005039 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005040 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005041 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005042 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005043 return Compatible;
5044 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005045
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005046 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005047 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregor02a24ee2009-11-03 16:56:39 +00005048 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Nick Lewyckyc133e9e2010-08-05 06:27:49 +00005049 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005050 //
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005051 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005052 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005053 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005054
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005055 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
5056 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005057
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005058 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
5059 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00005060 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
5061 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
5062 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
5063 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005064 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +00005065 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005066 CK_Unknown);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005067 return result;
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005068}
5069
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005070QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005071 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00005072 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005073 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005074 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005075}
5076
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005077QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005078 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005079 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005080 QualType lhsType =
5081 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
5082 QualType rhsType =
5083 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005084
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005085 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005086 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005087 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005088
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005089 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
5090 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005091 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005092 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chandler Carruth629f9e42010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005093 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005094 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005095 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005096 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005097 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005098 return lhsType;
5099 }
5100
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005101 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005102 return rhsType;
Eric Christophere84f9eb2010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005103 } else if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) ==Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)){
5104 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
5105 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a
5106 // bitcast; no bits are changed but the result type is different.
5107 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
5108 return lhsType;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005109 }
Eric Christophere84f9eb2010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005110 }
Chandler Carruth629f9e42010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005111 }
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005112 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005113
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005114 // Handle the case of equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
5115 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType() &&
5116 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005117 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005118 return rhsType;
5119 }
5120
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005121 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5122 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5123 bool swapped = false;
5124 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5125 swapped = true;
5126 std::swap(rex, lex);
5127 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
5128 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005129
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005130 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005131 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005132 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00005133 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005134 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005135 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005136 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5137 return lhsType;
5138 }
5139 }
5140 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
5141 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5142 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005143 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005144 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5145 return lhsType;
5146 }
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005147 }
5148 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005149
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005150 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005151 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005152 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005153 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005154 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005155}
5156
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005157QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
5158 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar69d1d002009-01-05 22:42:10 +00005159 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005160 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005161
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005162 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005163
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005164 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5165 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5166 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005167
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005168 // Check for division by zero.
5169 if (isDiv &&
5170 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005171 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005172 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005173
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005174 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005175}
5176
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005177QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005178 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005179 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005180 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5181 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005182 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5183 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5184 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005185
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005186 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005187
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005188 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5189 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005190
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005191 // Check for remainder by zero.
5192 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005193 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5194 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005195
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005196 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005197}
5198
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005199QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005200 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005201 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5202 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5203 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5204 return compType;
5205 }
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005206
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005207 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005208
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005209 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005210 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5211 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5212 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005213 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005214 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005215
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005216 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5217 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005218 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005219 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5220
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005221 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005222
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005223 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005224 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005225
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005226 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5227 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005228 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5229 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005230 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005231 return QualType();
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005232 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005233
5234 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5235 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5236 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005237 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005238 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5239 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5240 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5241 return QualType();
5242 }
5243
5244 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5245 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5246 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005247 } else {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005248 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005249 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005250 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005251 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5252 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005253 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5254 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005255 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005256 return QualType();
5257 }
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005258 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005259 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005260 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5261 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5262 return QualType();
5263 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005264
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005265 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005266 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5267 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5268 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5269 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5270 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005271 }
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005272 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5273 }
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005274 return PExp->getType();
5275 }
5276 }
5277
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005278 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005279}
5280
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005281// C99 6.5.6
5282QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005283 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5284 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5285 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5286 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5287 return compType;
5288 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005289
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005290 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005291
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005292 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005293
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005294 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005295 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5296 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005297 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005298 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005299 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005300
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005301 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005302 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff430ee5a2009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005303 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005304
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005305 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005306
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005307 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5308 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5309 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5310 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5311 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5312 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5313 return QualType();
5314 }
5315
5316 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5317 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5318 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5319 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5320 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005321 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005322 return QualType();
5323 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005324
5325 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5326 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5327 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005328 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005329 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005330 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005331 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005332 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005333
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005334 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005335 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005336 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5337 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5338 return QualType();
5339 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005340
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005341 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005342 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5343 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5344 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5345 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5346 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5347 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005348 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005349 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5350
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005351 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005352 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005353 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005354
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005355 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005356 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman8e54ad02008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005357 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005358
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005359 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5360 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5361 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5362 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5363 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5364 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5365 return QualType();
5366 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005367
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005368 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5369 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5370 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5371 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005372 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005373 return QualType();
5374 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005375
5376 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5377 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5378 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5379 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5380 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005381 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5382 << rex->getSourceRange()
5383 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005384 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005385
Eli Friedman88d936b2009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005386 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5387 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5388 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5389 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5390 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5391 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5392 return QualType();
5393 }
5394 } else {
5395 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5396 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5397 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5398 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5399 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5400 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5401 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5402 return QualType();
5403 }
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005404 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005405
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005406 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5407 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5408 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5409 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5410 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005411 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005412 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005413
5414 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005415 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5416 }
5417 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005418
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005419 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005420}
5421
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005422// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005423QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005424 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005425 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005426 if (!lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
5427 !rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005428 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005429
Nate Begeman2207d792009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005430 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5431 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5432 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5433
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005434 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5435 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005436 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5437 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5438 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5439 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5440 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005441 }
Chris Lattner1dcf2c82007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005442 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005443 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005444
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005445 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005446
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005447 // Sanity-check shift operands
5448 llvm::APSInt Right;
5449 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar3f180c62009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005450 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5451 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn8045c732009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005452 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005453 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5454 else {
5455 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5456 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5457 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5458 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5459 }
5460 }
5461
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005462 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005463 return LHSTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005464}
5465
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005466static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
5467 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
5468 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
5469 return true;
5470 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
5471 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
5472 }
5473 return false;
5474}
5475
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005476// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005477QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005478 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005479 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) OpaqueOpc;
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005480
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005481 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005482 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005483 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005484
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005485 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5486 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005487
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005488 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
Ted Kremenekfbcb0eb2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00005489 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational) &&
5490 !lex->getLocStart().isMacroID() &&
5491 !rex->getLocStart().isMacroID()) {
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005492 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5493 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5494 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Chandler Carruth64d092c2010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005495 //
5496 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
5497 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
5498 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
5499 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
5500 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
5501 // result.
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005502 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5503 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005504 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped)) {
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005505 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Ted Kremenekfbcb0eb2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00005506 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005507 !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DRL->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005508 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5509 << 0 // self-
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005510 << (Opc == BO_EQ
5511 || Opc == BO_LE
5512 || Opc == BO_GE));
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005513 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
5514 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
5515 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
5516 // what is it always going to eval to?
5517 char always_evals_to;
5518 switch(Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005519 case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005520 always_evals_to = 0; // false
5521 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005522 case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005523 always_evals_to = 1; // true
5524 break;
5525 default:
5526 // best we can say is 'a constant'
5527 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
5528 break;
5529 }
5530 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5531 << 1 // array
5532 << always_evals_to);
5533 }
5534 }
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005535 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005536
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005537 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5538 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5539 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5540 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005541
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005542 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5543 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005544 Expr *literalString = 0;
5545 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005546 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005547 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005548 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005549 literalString = lex;
5550 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005551 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5552 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005553 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005554 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005555 literalString = rex;
5556 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5557 }
5558
5559 if (literalString) {
5560 std::string resultComparison;
5561 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005562 case BO_LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5563 case BO_GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5564 case BO_LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5565 case BO_GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5566 case BO_EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5567 case BO_NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005568 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5569 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005570
Douglas Gregord1e4d9b2010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005571 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5572 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5573 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek03a4bee2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005574 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005575 }
Ted Kremenek3ca0bf22007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005576 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005577
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005578 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
5579 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5580 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5581 else {
5582 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5583 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5584 }
5585
5586 lType = lex->getType();
5587 rType = rex->getType();
5588
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005589 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005590 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005591
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005592 if (isRelational) {
5593 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005594 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005595 } else {
Ted Kremenek72cb1ae2007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005596 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005597 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005598 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005599
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005600 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005601 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005602 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005603
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005604 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005605 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005606 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005607 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005608
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005609 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5610 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff77878cc2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005611 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005612 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005613 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005614 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005615 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005616
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005617 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005618 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5619 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005620 if (!isRelational &&
5621 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5622 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5623 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005624 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
5625 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005626 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5627 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005628 Diag(Loc,
5629 isSFINAEContext()?
5630 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
5631 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005632 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005633
5634 if (isSFINAEContext())
5635 return QualType();
5636
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005637 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005638 return ResultTy;
5639 }
5640 }
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005641 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5642 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5643 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5644 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5645 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5646 //
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005647 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005648 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005649 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005650 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005651 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005652 if (T.isNull()) {
5653 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5654 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5655 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005656 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005657 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005658 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005659 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005660 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005661 }
5662
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005663 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5664 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005665 return ResultTy;
5666 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005667 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5668 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5669 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5670 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5671 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5672 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5673 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5674 }
5675 } else if (!isRelational &&
5676 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5677 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5678 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5679 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5680 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5681 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5682 }
5683 } else {
5684 // Invalid
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005685 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005686 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005687 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005688 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005689 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005690 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe77fd3c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005691 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005692
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005693 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005694 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005695 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005696 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005697 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5698 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregor443c2122010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005699 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType,
5700 lType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005701 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5702 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005703 return ResultTy;
5704 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005705 if (LHSIsNull &&
5706 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5707 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregor443c2122010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005708 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType,
5709 rType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005710 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5711 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005712 return ResultTy;
5713 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005714
5715 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005716 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005717 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5718 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005719 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5720 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5721 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5722 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5723 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5724 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5725 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5726 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005727 // types.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005728 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005729 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005730 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005731 if (T.isNull()) {
5732 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005733 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005734 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005735 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005736 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005737 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005738 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005739 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005740 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005741
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005742 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5743 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005744 return ResultTy;
5745 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005746
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005747 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005748 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5749 return ResultTy;
5750 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005751
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005752 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005753 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005754 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5755 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005756
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005757 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedman26784c12009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005758 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005759 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005760 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005761 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005762 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005763 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005764 }
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005765 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005766 if (!isRelational
5767 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5768 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005769 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005770 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005771 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005772 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005773 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5774 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5775 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005776 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005777 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005778 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005779 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005780
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005781 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005782 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005783 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5784 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005785 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005786 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005787 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005788 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005789
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005790 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5791 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005792 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005793 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005794 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005795 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005796 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff87f3b932008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005797 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005798 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005799 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005800 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5801 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005802 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005803 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff20373222008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005804 }
Fariborz Jahanian7359f042007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005805 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005806 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
5807 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005808 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005809 bool isError = false;
5810 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
5811 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
5812 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005813 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005814 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005815 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005816 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5817 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5818 isError = true;
5819 } else
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005820 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005821
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005822 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005823 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattner149f1382009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005824 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005825 if (isError)
5826 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005827 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005828
5829 if (lType->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005830 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005831 else
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005832 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005833 return ResultTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005834 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005835
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005836 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005837 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5838 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005839 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005840 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005841 }
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005842 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5843 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005844 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005845 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005846 }
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005847 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005848}
5849
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005850/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005851/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005852/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5853/// types.
5854QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005855 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005856 bool isRelational) {
5857 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5858 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005859 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005860 if (vType.isNull())
5861 return vType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005862
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005863 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5864 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005865
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005866 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5867 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5868 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005869 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005870 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5871 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5872 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005873 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5874 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5875 << 0 // self-
5876 << 2 // "a constant"
5877 );
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005878 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005879
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005880 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005881 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
5882 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005883 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005884 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005885
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005886 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5887 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5888 // elements for floating point vectors.
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005889 if (lType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005890 return lType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005891
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005892 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005893 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005894 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005895 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattnerd013aa12009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005896 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005897 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5898
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005899 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005900 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005901 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5902}
5903
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005904inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005905 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005906 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5907 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5908 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
5909 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5910
5911 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5912 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005913
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005914 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005915
Steve Naroffa4332e22007-07-17 00:58:39 +00005916 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005917 return compType;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005918 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005919}
5920
5921inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005922 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
5923
5924 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
5925 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
5926 // is a constant.
5927 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !lex->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
Eli Friedman787b0942010-07-27 19:14:53 +00005928 rex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !rex->isValueDependent() &&
Chris Lattner23ef3e42010-07-15 00:26:43 +00005929 // Don't warn in macros.
Chris Lattnerb7690b42010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005930 !Loc.isMacroID()) {
5931 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
5932 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
5933 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
5934 Expr::EvalResult Result;
5935 if (rex->Evaluate(Result, Context) && !Result.HasSideEffects &&
5936 Result.Val.getInt() != 0 && Result.Val.getInt() != 1) {
5937 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
5938 << rex->getSourceRange()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005939 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||")
5940 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|");
Chris Lattnerb7690b42010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005941 }
5942 }
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005943
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005944 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5945 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5946 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005947
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005948 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5949 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005950
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005951 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson04905012009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005952 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005953
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005954 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
5955 // non-overloadable operands.
5956
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005957 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5958 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005959 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
5960 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
5961 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005962 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005963
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005964 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5965 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5966 // The result is a bool.
5967 return Context.BoolTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005968}
5969
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005970/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5971/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5972/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5973///
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005974static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005975 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5976 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5977 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5978 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005979 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005980 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5981 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5982 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
5983 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005984 }
5985 }
5986 return false;
5987}
5988
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005989/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
5990/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
5991static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005992 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005993 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005994 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005995 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
5996 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005997 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
5998 return false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005999
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006000 unsigned Diag = 0;
6001 bool NeedType = false;
6002 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006003 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006004 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006005 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6006 NeedType = true;
6007 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006008 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006009 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6010 NeedType = true;
6011 break;
Chris Lattnerca354fa2008-11-17 19:51:54 +00006012 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006013 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
6014 break;
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006015 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
6016 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006017 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006018 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
6019 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006020 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6021 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006022 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
6023 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregor86447ec2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00006024 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006025 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00006026 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006027 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006028 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
6029 break;
Steve Naroff4f6a7d72008-09-26 14:41:28 +00006030 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006031 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6032 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5daf5702008-11-22 18:39:36 +00006033 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
6034 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
6035 break;
Fariborz Jahanianba8d2d62008-11-22 20:25:50 +00006036 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
6037 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
6038 break;
Fariborz Jahanian2514a302009-12-15 23:59:41 +00006039 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
6040 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
6041 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006042 }
Steve Naroffd1861fd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00006043
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006044 SourceRange Assign;
6045 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
6046 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006047 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006048 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006049 else
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006050 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006051 return true;
6052}
6053
6054
6055
6056// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006057QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
6058 SourceLocation Loc,
6059 QualType CompoundType) {
6060 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
6061 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006062 return QualType();
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006063
6064 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
6065 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006066 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006067 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006068 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006069 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006070 ConvertPropertyAssignment(LHS, RHS, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006071 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006072 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
6073 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
6074 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006075 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006076 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006077 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006078 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006079
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006080 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
6081 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
6082 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006083 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006084 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
6085 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
6086 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006087 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ||
6088 UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) &&
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006089 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006090 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006091 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
6092 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
6093 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattner3e872092009-03-09 07:11:10 +00006094 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
6095 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006096 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006097 << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-")
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006098 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006099 }
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006100 }
6101 } else {
6102 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedman623712b2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00006103 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006104 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006105
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006106 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006107 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006108 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006109
Chris Lattner8b5dec32010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006110
6111 // Check to see if the destination operand is a dereferenced null pointer. If
6112 // so, and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
6113 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
6114 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
6115 // only handles the pattern "*null = whatever", which is a very syntactic
6116 // check.
6117 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()))
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006118 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref &&
Chris Lattner8b5dec32010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006119 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
6120 isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
6121 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
6122 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
6123 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange();
6124 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_indirection_through_null);
6125 }
6126
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006127 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
6128 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006129 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006130 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
6131 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006132 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00006133 // operand.
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006134 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006135}
6136
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006137// C99 6.5.17
6138QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis25973452010-06-30 10:53:14 +00006139 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
6140
Chris Lattner53fcaa92008-07-25 20:54:07 +00006141 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006142 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
6143 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
6144 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006145
6146 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
6147 // incomplete in C++).
6148
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006149 return RHS->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006150}
6151
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00006152/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
6153/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006154QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006155 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006156 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6157 return Context.DependentTy;
6158
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006159 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
6160 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006161
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006162 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
6163 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
6164 if (!isInc) {
6165 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6166 return QualType();
6167 }
6168 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
6169 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6170 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006171 // OK!
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00006172 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
6173 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006174
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006175 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006176 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006177 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6178 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
6179 << Op->getSourceRange();
6180 return QualType();
6181 }
6182
6183 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006184 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006185 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006186 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6187 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
6188 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
6189 return QualType();
6190 }
6191
6192 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006193 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006194 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006195 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006196 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006197 << ResType))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00006198 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006199 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006200 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006201 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6202 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6203 return QualType();
6204 }
Eli Friedman5b088a12010-01-03 00:20:48 +00006205 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006206 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
6207 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006208 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006209 } else {
6210 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00006211 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006212 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006213 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006214 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroffdd10e022007-08-23 21:37:33 +00006215 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006216 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006217 return QualType();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006218 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
6219 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
6220 // operand.
6221 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6222 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006223}
6224
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006225void Sema::ConvertPropertyAssignment(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, QualType& LHSTy) {
6226 bool copyInit = false;
6227 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
6228 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
6229 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
6230 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
6231 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
6232 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
6233 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
6234 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
6235 }
6236 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHSTy->isRecordType());
6237 }
6238 else
6239 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(LHS) &&
6240 LHSTy->isRecordType());
6241 if (copyInit) {
6242 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00006243 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006244 Expr *Arg = RHS;
6245 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(),
6246 Owned(Arg));
6247 if (!ArgE.isInvalid())
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00006248 RHS = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006249 }
6250}
6251
6252
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006253/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006254/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006255/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
6256/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
6257/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
6258/// - &(x) => x
6259/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6260/// - &s.xx => s
6261/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6262/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6263/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6264/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006265static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006266 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006267 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006268 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006269 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006270 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6271 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6272 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006273 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006274 return 0;
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006275 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006276 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006277 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006278 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6279 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006280 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6281 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6282 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6283 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6284 }
6285 return 0;
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006286 }
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006287 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6288 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006289
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006290 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006291 case UO_Real:
6292 case UO_Imag:
6293 case UO_Extension:
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006294 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6295 default:
6296 return 0;
6297 }
6298 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006299 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006300 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006301 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006302 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6303 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006304 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006305 default:
6306 return 0;
6307 }
6308}
6309
6310/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006311/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006312/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006313/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006314/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006315/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006316/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006317QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *OrigOp, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
6318 if (OrigOp->isTypeDependent())
Douglas Gregor9103bb22008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006319 return Context.DependentTy;
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006320 if (OrigOp->getType() == Context.OverloadTy)
6321 return Context.OverloadTy;
6322
6323 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6324 Expr *op = OrigOp->IgnoreParens();
Douglas Gregor9103bb22008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006325
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006326 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6327 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6328 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006329 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref)
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006330 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6331 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6332 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6333 }
6334 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6335 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6336 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006337 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner28be73f2008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006338 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes6b6609f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006339
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006340 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006341 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6342 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6343 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6344 if (isSFINAEContext())
6345 return QualType();
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006346 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) {
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006347 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006348 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) {
6349 // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer.
6350 // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo.
6351
6352 // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up.
6353 if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) {
6354 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
6355 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6356 return QualType();
6357 }
6358 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op);
6359 CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
6360
6361 // The id-expression was parenthesized.
6362 if (OrigOp != DRE) {
6363 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function)
6364 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6365
6366 // The method was named without a qualifier.
6367 } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) {
6368 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6369 << op->getSourceRange();
6370 }
6371
6372 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6373 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6374 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006375 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006376 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006377 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006378 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006379 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6380 << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006381 return QualType();
6382 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006383 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006384 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6385 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6386 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006387 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson09380262010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006388 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006389 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006390 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemanb104b1f2009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006391 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006392 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian0337f212009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006393 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6394 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6395 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6396 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6397 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson1d524c32009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006398 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6399 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson474e1022009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006400 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6401 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006402 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006403 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006404 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6405 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4020f872010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006406 // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register
6407 // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3)
John McCalld931b082010-08-26 03:08:43 +00006408 if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register &&
Fariborz Jahanian4020f872010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006409 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006410 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6411 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006412 return QualType();
6413 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006414 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006415 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006416 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor29882052008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006417 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006418 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6419 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006420 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006421 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006422 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6423 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006424 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006425 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6426 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6427 return QualType();
6428 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006429
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006430 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6431 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006432 }
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006433 }
Anders Carlsson196f7d02009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006434 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006435 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006436 }
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006437
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006438 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6439 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6440 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6441 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6442 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6443 }
6444
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006445 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Douglas Gregor8f70ddb2010-07-29 16:05:45 +00006446 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
6447 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006448 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
6449}
6450
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006451/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006452QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006453 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6454 return Context.DependentTy;
6455
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006456 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006457 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
6458 QualType Result;
6459
6460 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
6461 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
6462 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
6463 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
6464 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6465 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
6466 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
6467 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6468 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006469
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006470 if (Result.isNull()) {
6471 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
6472 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6473 return QualType();
6474 }
6475
6476 return Result;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006477}
6478
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006479static inline BinaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006480 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006481 BinaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006482 switch (Kind) {
6483 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006484 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break;
6485 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break;
6486 case tok::star: Opc = BO_Mul; break;
6487 case tok::slash: Opc = BO_Div; break;
6488 case tok::percent: Opc = BO_Rem; break;
6489 case tok::plus: Opc = BO_Add; break;
6490 case tok::minus: Opc = BO_Sub; break;
6491 case tok::lessless: Opc = BO_Shl; break;
6492 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BO_Shr; break;
6493 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BO_LE; break;
6494 case tok::less: Opc = BO_LT; break;
6495 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BO_GE; break;
6496 case tok::greater: Opc = BO_GT; break;
6497 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BO_NE; break;
6498 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BO_EQ; break;
6499 case tok::amp: Opc = BO_And; break;
6500 case tok::caret: Opc = BO_Xor; break;
6501 case tok::pipe: Opc = BO_Or; break;
6502 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BO_LAnd; break;
6503 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BO_LOr; break;
6504 case tok::equal: Opc = BO_Assign; break;
6505 case tok::starequal: Opc = BO_MulAssign; break;
6506 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BO_DivAssign; break;
6507 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BO_RemAssign; break;
6508 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BO_AddAssign; break;
6509 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BO_SubAssign; break;
6510 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break;
6511 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break;
6512 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BO_AndAssign; break;
6513 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BO_XorAssign; break;
6514 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BO_OrAssign; break;
6515 case tok::comma: Opc = BO_Comma; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006516 }
6517 return Opc;
6518}
6519
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006520static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006521 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006522 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006523 switch (Kind) {
6524 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006525 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PreInc; break;
6526 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PreDec; break;
6527 case tok::amp: Opc = UO_AddrOf; break;
6528 case tok::star: Opc = UO_Deref; break;
6529 case tok::plus: Opc = UO_Plus; break;
6530 case tok::minus: Opc = UO_Minus; break;
6531 case tok::tilde: Opc = UO_Not; break;
6532 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UO_LNot; break;
6533 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UO_Real; break;
6534 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UO_Imag; break;
6535 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006536 }
6537 return Opc;
6538}
6539
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006540/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6541/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6542/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006543ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006544 unsigned Op,
6545 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006546 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006547 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) Op;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006548 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6549 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6550 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006551
6552 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006553 case BO_Assign:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006554 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6555 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006556 case BO_PtrMemD:
6557 case BO_PtrMemI:
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006558 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006559 Opc == BO_PtrMemI);
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006560 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006561 case BO_Mul:
6562 case BO_Div:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006563 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006564 Opc == BO_Div);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006565 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006566 case BO_Rem:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006567 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6568 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006569 case BO_Add:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006570 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6571 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006572 case BO_Sub:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006573 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6574 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006575 case BO_Shl:
6576 case BO_Shr:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006577 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6578 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006579 case BO_LE:
6580 case BO_LT:
6581 case BO_GE:
6582 case BO_GT:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006583 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006584 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006585 case BO_EQ:
6586 case BO_NE:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006587 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006588 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006589 case BO_And:
6590 case BO_Xor:
6591 case BO_Or:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006592 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6593 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006594 case BO_LAnd:
6595 case BO_LOr:
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006596 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006597 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006598 case BO_MulAssign:
6599 case BO_DivAssign:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006600 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006601 Opc == BO_DivAssign);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006602 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6603 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6604 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006605 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006606 case BO_RemAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006607 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6608 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6609 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6610 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006611 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006612 case BO_AddAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006613 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6614 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6615 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006616 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006617 case BO_SubAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006618 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6619 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6620 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006621 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006622 case BO_ShlAssign:
6623 case BO_ShrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006624 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6625 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6626 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6627 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006628 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006629 case BO_AndAssign:
6630 case BO_XorAssign:
6631 case BO_OrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006632 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6633 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6634 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6635 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006636 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006637 case BO_Comma:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006638 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6639 break;
6640 }
6641 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006642 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian57dae1a2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006643 if (ResultTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006644 if (Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign)
Fariborz Jahanian57dae1a2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006645 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_assignment_requires_nonfragile_object)
6646 << ResultTy;
6647 }
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006648 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006649 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6650 else
6651 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006652 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6653 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006654}
6655
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006656/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6657/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006658static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6659 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006660 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6661 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6662 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006663 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006664 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6665
6666 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6667 return;
6668
6669 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6670 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6671 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006672 return;
6673 }
6674
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006675 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6676 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006677 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006678
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006679 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006680 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006681
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006682 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6683 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6684 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6685 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006686 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006687 return;
6688 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006689
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006690 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006691 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6692 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006693}
6694
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006695/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6696/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6697/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6698/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006699static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006700 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006701 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6702 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6703 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6704 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006705 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006706 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006707 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6708
6709 // Subs are not binary operators.
6710 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6711 return;
6712
6713 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6714 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006715 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6716 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006717 return;
6718
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006719 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006720 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006721 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006722 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6723 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006724 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006725 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006726 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6727 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6728 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6729 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006730 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006731 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006732 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006733 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6734 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006735 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006736 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006737 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6738 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6739 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6740 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006741}
6742
6743/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6744/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6745/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006746static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006747 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006748 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006749 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6750}
6751
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006752// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006753ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006754 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6755 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
6756 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006757 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6758 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006759
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006760 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6761 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6762
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006763 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6764}
6765
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006766ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006767 BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
6768 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006769 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006770 ((!isa<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(lhs) &&
6771 !isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(lhs))
Fariborz Jahanianeb17e8b2010-09-17 20:45:45 +00006772 || rhs->isTypeDependent() || Opc != BO_Assign) &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006773 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006774 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6775 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6776 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6777 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6778 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006779 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006780 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006781 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6782 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6783 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006784
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006785 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6786 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006787 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006788 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006789
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006790 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006791 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006792}
6793
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006794ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006795 unsigned OpcIn,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006796 Expr *Input) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006797 UnaryOperatorKind Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperatorKind>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006798
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006799 QualType resultType;
6800 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006801 case UO_PreInc:
6802 case UO_PreDec:
6803 case UO_PostInc:
6804 case UO_PostDec:
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006805 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006806 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6807 Opc == UO_PostInc,
6808 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6809 Opc == UO_PreDec);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006810 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006811 case UO_AddrOf:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006812 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
6813 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006814 case UO_Deref:
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006815 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006816 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
6817 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006818 case UO_Plus:
6819 case UO_Minus:
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006820 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6821 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006822 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6823 break;
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00006824 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6825 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006826 break;
6827 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6828 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6829 break;
6830 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006831 Opc == UO_Plus &&
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006832 resultType->isPointerType())
6833 break;
6834
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006835 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6836 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006837 case UO_Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006838 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6839 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006840 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6841 break;
Chris Lattner02a65142008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006842 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6843 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6844 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006845 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006846 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006847 else if (!resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006848 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6849 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006850 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006851 case UO_LNot: // logical negation
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006852 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006853 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006854 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006855 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6856 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006857 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006858 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6859 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregorea844f32010-09-20 17:13:33 +00006860
6861 // Do not accept &f if f is overloaded
6862 // i.e. void f(int); void f(char); bool b = &f;
6863 if (resultType == Context.OverloadTy &&
6864 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Input))
6865 return ExprError(); // Diagnostic is uttered above
6866
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006867 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006868 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6869 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006870 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006871 case UO_Real:
6872 case UO_Imag:
6873 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real);
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006874 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006875 case UO_Extension:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006876 resultType = Input->getType();
6877 break;
6878 }
6879 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006880 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006881
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006882 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006883}
6884
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006885ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006886 UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
6887 Expr *Input) {
Anders Carlssona8a1e3d2009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006888 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
Eli Friedman957c0942010-09-05 23:15:52 +00006889 UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc) != OO_None) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006890 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6891 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6892 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6893 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006894 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006895 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006896 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6897 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6898 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006899
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006900 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006901 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006902
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006903 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006904}
6905
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006906// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006907ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006908 tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) {
6909 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input);
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006910}
6911
Steve Naroff1b273c42007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006912/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006913ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006914 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6915 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006916 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +00006917 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getCurFunction()->LabelMap[LabelII];
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006918
Daniel Dunbar0ffb1252008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006919 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6920 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroffcaaacec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006921 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006922 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006923
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00006924 LabelDecl->setUsed();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006925 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006926 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6927 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006928}
6929
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006930ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006931Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006932 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006933 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6934 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6935
Douglas Gregordd8f5692010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006936 bool isFileScope
6937 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattner4a049f02009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006938 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006939 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedmandca2b732009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006940
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006941 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6942 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6943 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006944
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006945 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6946 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6947 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006948
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006949 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6950 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6951 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6952 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6953 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006954
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006955 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006956 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006957 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006958
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006959 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6960 // expressions are not lvalues.
6961
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006962 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006963}
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006964
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006965ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006966 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006967 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6968 unsigned NumComponents,
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006969 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6970 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006971 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnarabd054db2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00006972 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006973
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006974 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6975 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6976 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006977 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006978 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6979 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
6980
6981 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6982 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
6983 if (!Dependent
6984 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
6985 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
6986 << TypeRange))
6987 return ExprError();
6988
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006989 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6990 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman35183ac2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006991 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6992 // a system header!
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006993 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006994 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6995 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006996
6997 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
6998 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
6999 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
7000 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
7001 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
7002 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
7003 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
7004 if (OC.isBrackets) {
7005 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
7006 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7007 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
7008 if(!AT)
7009 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
7010 << CurrentType);
7011 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
7012 } else
7013 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7014
7015 // The expression must be an integral expression.
7016 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
7017 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
7018 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
7019 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
7020 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
7021 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
7022 << Idx->getSourceRange());
7023
7024 // Record this array index.
7025 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
7026 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
7027 continue;
7028 }
7029
7030 // Offset of a field.
7031 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7032 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
7033 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
7034 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
7035 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7036 continue;
7037 }
7038
7039 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
7040 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
7041 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
7042 return ExprError();
7043
7044 // Look for the designated field.
7045 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
7046 if (!RC)
7047 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
7048 << CurrentType);
7049 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
7050
7051 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
7052 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
7053 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
7054 // (clause 9).
7055 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
7056 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
7057 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
7058 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
7059 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
7060 << CurrentType))
7061 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
7062 }
7063
7064 // Look for the field.
7065 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
7066 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
7067 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
7068 if (!MemberDecl)
7069 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
7070 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
7071 OC.LocEnd));
7072
Douglas Gregor9d5d60f2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00007073 // C99 7.17p3:
7074 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
7075 //
7076 // We diagnose this as an error.
7077 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
7078 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
7079 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
7080 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
7081 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
7082 return ExprError();
7083 }
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007084
7085 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
7086 bool AnonStructUnion = Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion();
7087 if (AnonStructUnion) {
7088 do {
7089 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(Parent->getParent());
7090 } while (Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
7091 }
7092
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007093 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
7094 // the base class indirections.
7095 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
7096 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007097 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) {
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007098 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
7099 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
7100 B != BEnd; ++B)
7101 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
7102 }
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007103
7104 if (AnonStructUnion) {
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007105 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
7106 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
7107 unsigned n = Path.size();
7108 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
7109 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
7110 } else {
7111 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
7112 }
7113 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
7114 }
7115
7116 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
7117 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
7118 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
7119}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007120
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007121ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007122 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7123 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007124 ParsedType argty,
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007125 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7126 unsigned NumComponents,
7127 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7128
7129 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
7130 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
7131 if (ArgTy.isNull())
7132 return ExprError();
7133
Eli Friedman5a15dc12010-08-05 10:15:45 +00007134 if (!ArgTInfo)
7135 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
7136
7137 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
7138 RPLoc);
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007139}
7140
7141
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007142ExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007143 ParsedType arg1,ParsedType arg2,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007144 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007145 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1;
7146 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1, &argTInfo1);
7147 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2;
7148 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2, &argTInfo2);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007149
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007150 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007151
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007152 return BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(BuiltinLoc, argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc);
7153}
7154
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007155ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007156Sema::BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7157 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1,
7158 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2,
7159 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Douglas Gregorc12a9c52009-05-19 22:28:02 +00007160 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7161 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
7162 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7163 return ExprError();
7164 }
7165
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007166 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007167 argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007168}
7169
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007170
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007171ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007172 Expr *CondExpr,
7173 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007174 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007175 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
7176
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007177 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007178 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregorc9ecc572009-05-19 22:43:30 +00007179 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007180 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007181 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007182 } else {
7183 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
7184 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
7185 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
7186 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007187 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
7188 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
7189 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007190
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007191 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7192 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007193 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7194 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007195 }
7196
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007197 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007198 resType, RPLoc,
7199 resType->isDependentType(),
7200 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007201}
7202
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007203//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7204// Clang Extensions.
7205//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7206
7207/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007208void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007209 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7210 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7211 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
Fariborz Jahaniana729da22010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007212 if (BlockScope)
7213 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
7214 else
7215 CurContext = Block;
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007216}
7217
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007218void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007219 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007220 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007221
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007222 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007223 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007224 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007225
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007226 bool isVariadic;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007227 QualType RetTy;
7228 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007229 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007230 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007231 isVariadic =
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007232 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7233 } else {
7234 RetTy = T;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007235 isVariadic = false;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007236 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007237
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007238 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007239
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007240 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7241 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7242 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007243 return;
7244 }
7245
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007246 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7247 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7248 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7249 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7250 return;
7251 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007252
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007253 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007254 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7255 // ^ * { ... }
7256 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007257 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7258 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007259
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007260 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007261 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007262 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7263 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7264 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7265 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007266 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7267 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7268 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7269 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7270 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007271 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007272 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007273
7274 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7275 // ^ fntype { ... }
7276 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7277 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7278 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7279 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7280 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7281 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7282 *I);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007283 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007284 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007285 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007286
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007287 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
7288 if (!Params.empty())
7289 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007290
7291 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor9cdda0c2009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007292 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007293
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007294 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007295 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7296 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7297 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7298 }
7299
7300 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7301 // if we don't have any.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007302 if (Params.empty())
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007303 return;
7304
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007305 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7306 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7307
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007308 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007309 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7310 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7311
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007312 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007313 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7314 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7315 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7316
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007317 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007318 }
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007319 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007320}
7321
7322/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7323/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7324void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007325 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner5c59e2b2009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007326 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007327 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007328 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007329}
7330
7331/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7332/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007333ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007334 Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9af55002009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007335 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7336 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7337 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007338
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007339 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Fariborz Jahaniana729da22010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007340
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007341 PopDeclContext();
7342
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007343 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007344 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7345 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007346
Mike Stump56925862009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007347 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007348 QualType BlockTy;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007349
7350 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7351 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7352 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7353
7354 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7355 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7356
7357 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7358 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7359 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7360 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7361
7362 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7363 // preserve its sugar structure.
7364 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7365 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7366 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7367
7368 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7369 } else {
7370 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7371 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7372 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7373 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7374 FPT->isVariadic(),
7375 /*quals*/ 0,
7376 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7377 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7378 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7379 FPT->exception_begin(),
7380 Ext);
7381 }
7382
7383 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7384 } else {
7385 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7386 false, false, 0, 0,
7387 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7388 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007389
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007390 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007391 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7392 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007393 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007394
Chris Lattner17a78302009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007395 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +00007396 if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007397 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007398
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007399 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007400
7401 bool Good = true;
7402 // Check goto/label use.
7403 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7404 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7405 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7406
7407 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7408 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007409 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0) {
7410 if (!L->isUsed())
7411 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::warn_unused_label) << L->getName();
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007412 continue;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007413 }
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007414
7415 // Emit error.
7416 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7417 Good = false;
7418 }
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007419 if (!Good) {
7420 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007421 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007422 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007423
John McCalle0054f62010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007424 BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7425 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
7426
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007427 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenekd064fdc2010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007428 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7429 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
John McCalle0054f62010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007430 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, Result);
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007431
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007432 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007433 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007434}
7435
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007436ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007437 Expr *expr, ParsedType type,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007438 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007439 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
7440 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type, &TInfo);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007441 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, expr, TInfo, RPLoc);
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007442}
7443
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007444ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007445 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007446 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007447 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007448
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007449 // Get the va_list type
7450 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007451 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7452 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7453 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7454 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007455 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007456 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7457 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7458 } else {
7459 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7460 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007461 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007462 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007463 return ExprError();
7464 }
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007465
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007466 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7467 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007468 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7469 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007470 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9dc8f192009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007471 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007472
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007473 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007474 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007475
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007476 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
7477 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T));
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007478}
7479
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007480ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007481 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7482 // pointers on the target.
7483 QualType Ty;
7484 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7485 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7486 else
7487 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7488
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007489 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007490}
7491
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007492static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007493 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007494 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7495 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007496
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007497 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7498 if (!PT)
7499 return;
7500
7501 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7502 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7503 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7504 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7505 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7506 return;
7507 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007508
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007509 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7510 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7511 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7512 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007513
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007514 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007515}
7516
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007517bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7518 SourceLocation Loc,
7519 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007520 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7521 bool *Complained) {
7522 if (Complained)
7523 *Complained = false;
7524
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007525 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7526 bool isInvalid = false;
7527 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007528 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007529
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007530 switch (ConvTy) {
7531 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7532 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007533 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007534 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7535 break;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007536 case IntToPointer:
7537 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7538 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007539 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007540 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007541 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7542 break;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007543 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7544 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7545 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007546 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7547 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7548 break;
7549 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007550 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7551 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7552 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7553 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7554 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7555 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7556 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7557 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7558 // C++ semantics.
7559 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7560 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7561 return false;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007562 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7563 break;
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007564 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanian3451e922009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007565 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007566 break;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007567 case IntToBlockPointer:
7568 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7569 break;
7570 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stump25efa102009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007571 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007572 break;
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007573 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007574 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007575 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7576 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7577 break;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007578 case IncompatibleVectors:
7579 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7580 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007581 case Incompatible:
7582 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7583 isInvalid = true;
7584 break;
7585 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007586
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007587 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7588 switch (Action) {
7589 case AA_Assigning:
7590 case AA_Initializing:
7591 // The destination type comes first.
7592 FirstType = DstType;
7593 SecondType = SrcType;
7594 break;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007595
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007596 case AA_Returning:
7597 case AA_Passing:
7598 case AA_Converting:
7599 case AA_Sending:
7600 case AA_Casting:
7601 // The source type comes first.
7602 FirstType = SrcType;
7603 SecondType = DstType;
7604 break;
7605 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007606
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007607 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007608 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007609 if (Complained)
7610 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007611 return isInvalid;
7612}
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007613
Chris Lattner3bf68932009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007614bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007615 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7616 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7617 if (Result)
7618 *Result = ICEResult;
7619 return false;
7620 }
7621
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007622 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7623
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007624 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007625 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7626 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7627
7628 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7629 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7630 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7631 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7632 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7633 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7634 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007635
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007636 return true;
7637 }
7638
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007639 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7640 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007641
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007642 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7643 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7644 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007645
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007646 if (Result)
7647 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7648 return false;
7649}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007650
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007651void
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007652Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007653 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7654 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007655}
7656
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007657void
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007658Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7659 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7660 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7661 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007662
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007663 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7664 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7665 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7666 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7667 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007668 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007669 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7670 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7671 I != IEnd; ++I)
7672 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7673 }
7674
7675 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7676 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7677 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7678 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7679 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7680 I != IEnd; ++I)
7681 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7682 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007683 }
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007684
7685 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7686 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7687 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7688 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007689 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007690 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7691 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7692 ExprTemporaries.end());
7693
7694 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7695 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007696}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007697
7698/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7699///
7700/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7701/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7702/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7703/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7704///
7705/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7706///
7707/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7708void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7709 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007710
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007711 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007712 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007713
Douglas Gregorb5352cf2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007714 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7715 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7716 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7717 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007718 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007719 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007720 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007721 return;
7722 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007723
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007724 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7725 return;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007726
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007727 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7728 // an instantiation.
7729 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7730 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007731
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007732 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007733 case Unevaluated:
7734 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7735 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007736
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007737 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7738 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7739 // "used"; handle this below.
7740 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007741
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007742 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7743 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7744 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7745 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007746 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007747 return;
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007748
7749 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
7750 // Referenced declarations will only be used if the construct in the
7751 // containing expression is used.
7752 return;
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007753 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007754
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007755 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanianb7f4cc02009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007756 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007757 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian05a5c452009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007758 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Chandler Carruth4e6fbce2010-08-23 07:55:51 +00007759 if (Constructor->getParent()->hasTrivialConstructor())
7760 return;
7761 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
7762 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007763 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor9e9199d2009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007764 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007765 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007766 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7767 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007768
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007769 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007770 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007771 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007772 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007773 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7774 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007775 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7776 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7777 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007778 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor39957dc2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007779 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007780 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7781 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007782 }
Fariborz Jahanianf5ed9e02009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007783 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007784 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor1637be72009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007785 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor6cfacfe2010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007786 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007787 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7788 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7789 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7790 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7791 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007792 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007793 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007794 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007795 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007796 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7797 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7798 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007799 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007800 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007801 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7802 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007803
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007804 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7805 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7806 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7807 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7808 Loc));
7809 else
Chandler Carruth62c78d52010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007810 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function, Loc));
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007811 }
Gabor Greif40181c42010-08-28 00:16:06 +00007812 } else // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable.
7813 for (FunctionDecl::redecl_iterator i(Function->redecls_begin()),
7814 e(Function->redecls_end()); i != e; ++i) {
Gabor Greifbe9ebe32010-08-28 01:58:12 +00007815 if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable())
Gabor Greif40181c42010-08-28 00:16:06 +00007816 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *i);
7817 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007818
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007819 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Argyrios Kyrtzidis58b52592010-08-25 10:34:54 +00007820
7821 // Recursive functions should be marked when used from another function.
7822 if (CurContext != Function)
7823 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007824
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007825 return;
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007826 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007827
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007828 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007829 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007830 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007831 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7832 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7833 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7834 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7835 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7836 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Chandler Carruth62c78d52010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007837 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007838 }
7839 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007840
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007841 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007842
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007843 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007844 return;
Sam Weinigcce6ebc2009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007845 }
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007846}
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007847
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007848namespace {
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007849 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007850 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007851 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007852 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7853 Sema &S;
7854 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007855
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007856 public:
7857 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007858
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007859 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007860
7861 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7862 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007863 };
7864}
7865
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007866bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
7867 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007868 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7869 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7870 }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007871
7872 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007873}
7874
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007875bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007876 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7877 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7878 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007879 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7880 Args.flat_size());
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007881 }
7882
Chandler Carruthe3e210c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00007883 return true;
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007884}
7885
7886void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
7887 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007888 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007889}
7890
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007891namespace {
7892 /// \brief Helper class that marks all of the declarations referenced by
7893 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
7894 class EvaluatedExprMarker : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> {
7895 Sema &S;
7896
7897 public:
7898 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> Inherited;
7899
7900 explicit EvaluatedExprMarker(Sema &S) : Inherited(S.Context), S(S) { }
7901
7902 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
7903 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
7904 }
7905
7906 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
7907 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getMemberLoc(), E->getMemberDecl());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00007908 Inherited::VisitMemberExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007909 }
7910
7911 void VisitCXXNewExpr(CXXNewExpr *E) {
7912 if (E->getConstructor())
7913 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
7914 if (E->getOperatorNew())
7915 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorNew());
7916 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
7917 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00007918 Inherited::VisitCXXNewExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007919 }
7920
7921 void VisitCXXDeleteExpr(CXXDeleteExpr *E) {
7922 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
7923 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor5833b0b2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00007924 QualType Destroyed = S.Context.getBaseElementType(E->getDestroyedType());
7925 if (const RecordType *DestroyedRec = Destroyed->getAs<RecordType>()) {
7926 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DestroyedRec->getDecl());
7927 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(),
7928 S.LookupDestructor(Record));
7929 }
7930
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00007931 Inherited::VisitCXXDeleteExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007932 }
7933
7934 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) {
7935 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00007936 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007937 }
7938
7939 void VisitBlockDeclRefExpr(BlockDeclRefExpr *E) {
7940 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
7941 }
7942 };
7943}
7944
7945/// \brief Mark any declarations that appear within this expression or any
7946/// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
7947void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr *E) {
7948 EvaluatedExprMarker(*this).Visit(E);
7949}
7950
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007951/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7952/// of the program being compiled.
7953///
7954/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007955/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007956/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7957/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7958/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7959/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007960/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007961/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007962///
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007963/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7964/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7965/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7966/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007967bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007968 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7969 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7970 case Unevaluated:
7971 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7972 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007973
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007974 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007975 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007976 Diag(Loc, PD);
7977 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007978
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007979 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7980 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7981 break;
7982 }
7983
7984 return false;
7985}
7986
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007987bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
7988 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
7989 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
7990 return false;
7991
7992 PartialDiagnostic Note =
7993 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
7994 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
7995 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007996
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007997 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007998 FD ?
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007999 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
8000 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008001 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008002 << CE->getSourceRange(),
8003 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
8004 return true;
8005
8006 return false;
8007}
8008
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008009// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
8010// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
8011void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
8012 SourceLocation Loc;
8013
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008014 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
8015
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008016 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
8017 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008018 if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign)
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008019 return;
8020
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008021 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
8022 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
8023 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
8024 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
8025
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008026 // self = [<foo> init...]
8027 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
8028 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
8029 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8030
8031 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
8032 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
8033 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
8034 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8035 }
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008036
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008037 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8038 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
8039 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
8040 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
8041 return;
8042
8043 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8044 } else {
8045 // Not an assignment.
8046 return;
8047 }
8048
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008049 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCall2d152152009-10-12 22:25:59 +00008050 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008051
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008052 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00008053 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008054 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008055 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
8056 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
8057 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008058}
8059
8060bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
8061 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
8062
8063 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00008064 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008065
8066 QualType T = E->getType();
8067
8068 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
8069 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
8070 return true;
8071 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
8072 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
8073 << T << E->getSourceRange();
8074 return true;
8075 }
8076 }
8077
8078 return false;
8079}
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008080
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008081ExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
8082 Expr *Sub) {
Douglas Gregoreecf38f2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00008083 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008084 return ExprError();
8085
Douglas Gregorff331c12010-07-25 18:17:45 +00008086 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc))
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008087 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008088
8089 return Owned(Sub);
8090}